X-Git-Url: https://pintos-os.org/cgi-bin/gitweb.cgi?a=blobdiff_plain;f=doc%2Ftexinfo.tex;h=d5c8121fa34a7262af144be68eecc066f0071895;hb=2e0595dd8e344dbdcab740d7d2a3b67d153d6b39;hp=d4e7739444526b291edf12c01c47bf83b49ce45e;hpb=fa77efde13ecbb261b90109142453850b283b950;p=pspp-builds.git diff --git a/doc/texinfo.tex b/doc/texinfo.tex index d4e77394..d5c8121f 100644 --- a/doc/texinfo.tex +++ b/doc/texinfo.tex @@ -1,185 +1,316 @@ -%% TeX macros to handle texinfo files - -% Copyright (C) 1985, 86, 88, 90, 91, 92, 93, 1994 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - -%This texinfo.tex file is free software; you can redistribute it and/or -%modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as -%published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at -%your option) any later version. - -%This texinfo.tex file is distributed in the hope that it will be -%useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty -%of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU -%General Public License for more details. - -%You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License -%along with this texinfo.tex file; see the file COPYING. If not, write -%to the Free Software Foundation, 675 Mass Ave, Cambridge, MA 02139, -%USA. - - -%In other words, you are welcome to use, share and improve this program. -%You are forbidden to forbid anyone else to use, share and improve -%what you give them. Help stamp out software-hoarding! - - -% Send bug reports to bug-texinfo@prep.ai.mit.edu. -% Please include a *precise* test case in each bug report. - - -% Make it possible to create a .fmt file just by loading this file: -% if the underlying format is not loaded, start by loading it now. -% Added by gildea November 1993. +% texinfo.tex -- TeX macros to handle Texinfo files. +% +% Load plain if necessary, i.e., if running under initex. \expandafter\ifx\csname fmtname\endcsname\relax\input plain\fi +% +\def\texinfoversion{2003-10-06.08} +% +% Copyright (C) 1985, 1986, 1988, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, +% 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc. +% +% This texinfo.tex file is free software; you can redistribute it and/or +% modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as +% published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at +% your option) any later version. +% +% This texinfo.tex file is distributed in the hope that it will be +% useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty +% of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU +% General Public License for more details. +% +% You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License +% along with this texinfo.tex file; see the file COPYING. If not, write +% to the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, +% Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. +% +% In other words, you are welcome to use, share and improve this program. +% You are forbidden to forbid anyone else to use, share and improve +% what you give them. Help stamp out software-hoarding! +% +% Please try the latest version of texinfo.tex before submitting bug +% reports; you can get the latest version from: +% ftp://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/texinfo/texinfo.tex +% (and all GNU mirrors, see http://www.gnu.org/order/ftp.html) +% ftp://tug.org/tex/texinfo.tex +% (and all CTAN mirrors, see http://www.ctan.org), +% and /home/gd/gnu/doc/texinfo.tex on the GNU machines. +% +% The GNU Texinfo home page is http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo. +% +% The texinfo.tex in any given Texinfo distribution could well be out +% of date, so if that's what you're using, please check. +% +% Send bug reports to bug-texinfo@gnu.org. Please include including a +% complete document in each bug report with which we can reproduce the +% problem. Patches are, of course, greatly appreciated. +% +% To process a Texinfo manual with TeX, it's most reliable to use the +% texi2dvi shell script that comes with the distribution. For a simple +% manual foo.texi, however, you can get away with this: +% tex foo.texi +% texindex foo.?? +% tex foo.texi +% tex foo.texi +% dvips foo.dvi -o # or whatever; this makes foo.ps. +% The extra TeX runs get the cross-reference information correct. +% Sometimes one run after texindex suffices, and sometimes you need more +% than two; texi2dvi does it as many times as necessary. +% +% It is possible to adapt texinfo.tex for other languages, to some +% extent. You can get the existing language-specific files from the +% full Texinfo distribution. -% This automatically updates the version number based on RCS. -\def\deftexinfoversion$#1: #2 ${\def\texinfoversion{#2}} -\deftexinfoversion$Revision: 1.2 $ -\message{Loading texinfo package [Version \texinfoversion]:} +\message{Loading texinfo [version \texinfoversion]:} % If in a .fmt file, print the version number % and turn on active characters that we couldn't do earlier because % they might have appeared in the input file name. -\everyjob{\message{[Texinfo version \texinfoversion]}\message{} +\everyjob{\message{[Texinfo version \texinfoversion]}% \catcode`+=\active \catcode`\_=\active} -% Save some parts of plain tex whose names we will redefine. +\message{Basics,} +\chardef\other=12 -\let\ptextilde=\~ -\let\ptexlbrace=\{ -\let\ptexrbrace=\} -\let\ptexdots=\dots -\let\ptexdot=\. -\let\ptexstar=\* -\let\ptexend=\end -\let\ptexbullet=\bullet +% We never want plain's \outer definition of \+ in Texinfo. +% For @tex, we can use \tabalign. +\let\+ = \relax + +% Save some plain tex macros whose names we will redefine. \let\ptexb=\b +\let\ptexbullet=\bullet \let\ptexc=\c +\let\ptexcomma=\, +\let\ptexdot=\. +\let\ptexdots=\dots +\let\ptexend=\end +\let\ptexequiv=\equiv +\let\ptexexclam=\! +\let\ptexgtr=> +\let\ptexhat=^ \let\ptexi=\i +\let\ptexindent=\indent +\let\ptexnoindent=\noindent +\let\ptexlbrace=\{ +\let\ptexless=< +\let\ptexplus=+ +\let\ptexrbrace=\} +\let\ptexslash=\/ +\let\ptexstar=\* \let\ptext=\t -\let\ptexl=\l -\let\ptexL=\L - -% Be sure we're in horizontal mode when doing a tie, since we make space -% equivalent to this in @example-like environments. Otherwise, a space -% at the beginning of a line will start with \penalty -- and -% since \penalty is valid in vertical mode, we'd end up putting the -% penalty on the vertical list instead of in the new paragraph. -{\catcode`@ = 11 - \gdef\tie{\leavevmode\penalty\@M\ } -} -\let\~ = \tie % And make it available as @~. - -\message{Basics,} -\chardef\other=12 % If this character appears in an error message or help string, it % starts a new line in the output. \newlinechar = `^^J -% Set up fixed words for English. -\ifx\putwordChapter\undefined{\gdef\putwordChapter{Chapter}}\fi% -\def\putwordInfo{Info}% -\ifx\putwordSee\undefined{\gdef\putwordSee{See}}\fi% -\ifx\putwordsee\undefined{\gdef\putwordsee{see}}\fi% -\ifx\putwordfile\undefined{\gdef\putwordfile{file}}\fi% -\ifx\putwordpage\undefined{\gdef\putwordpage{page}}\fi% -\ifx\putwordsection\undefined{\gdef\putwordsection{section}}\fi% -\ifx\putwordSection\undefined{\gdef\putwordSection{Section}}\fi% -\ifx\putwordTableofContents\undefined{\gdef\putwordTableofContents{Table of Contents}}\fi% -\ifx\putwordShortContents\undefined{\gdef\putwordShortContents{Short Contents}}\fi% -\ifx\putwordAppendix\undefined{\gdef\putwordAppendix{Appendix}}\fi% +% Set up fixed words for English if not already set. +\ifx\putwordAppendix\undefined \gdef\putwordAppendix{Appendix}\fi +\ifx\putwordChapter\undefined \gdef\putwordChapter{Chapter}\fi +\ifx\putwordfile\undefined \gdef\putwordfile{file}\fi +\ifx\putwordin\undefined \gdef\putwordin{in}\fi +\ifx\putwordIndexIsEmpty\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexIsEmpty{(Index is empty)}\fi +\ifx\putwordIndexNonexistent\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexNonexistent{(Index is nonexistent)}\fi +\ifx\putwordInfo\undefined \gdef\putwordInfo{Info}\fi +\ifx\putwordInstanceVariableof\undefined \gdef\putwordInstanceVariableof{Instance Variable of}\fi +\ifx\putwordMethodon\undefined \gdef\putwordMethodon{Method on}\fi +\ifx\putwordNoTitle\undefined \gdef\putwordNoTitle{No Title}\fi +\ifx\putwordof\undefined \gdef\putwordof{of}\fi +\ifx\putwordon\undefined \gdef\putwordon{on}\fi +\ifx\putwordpage\undefined \gdef\putwordpage{page}\fi +\ifx\putwordsection\undefined \gdef\putwordsection{section}\fi +\ifx\putwordSection\undefined \gdef\putwordSection{Section}\fi +\ifx\putwordsee\undefined \gdef\putwordsee{see}\fi +\ifx\putwordSee\undefined \gdef\putwordSee{See}\fi +\ifx\putwordShortTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordShortTOC{Short Contents}\fi +\ifx\putwordTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordTOC{Table of Contents}\fi +% +\ifx\putwordMJan\undefined \gdef\putwordMJan{January}\fi +\ifx\putwordMFeb\undefined \gdef\putwordMFeb{February}\fi +\ifx\putwordMMar\undefined \gdef\putwordMMar{March}\fi +\ifx\putwordMApr\undefined \gdef\putwordMApr{April}\fi +\ifx\putwordMMay\undefined \gdef\putwordMMay{May}\fi +\ifx\putwordMJun\undefined \gdef\putwordMJun{June}\fi +\ifx\putwordMJul\undefined \gdef\putwordMJul{July}\fi +\ifx\putwordMAug\undefined \gdef\putwordMAug{August}\fi +\ifx\putwordMSep\undefined \gdef\putwordMSep{September}\fi +\ifx\putwordMOct\undefined \gdef\putwordMOct{October}\fi +\ifx\putwordMNov\undefined \gdef\putwordMNov{November}\fi +\ifx\putwordMDec\undefined \gdef\putwordMDec{December}\fi +% +\ifx\putwordDefmac\undefined \gdef\putwordDefmac{Macro}\fi +\ifx\putwordDefspec\undefined \gdef\putwordDefspec{Special Form}\fi +\ifx\putwordDefvar\undefined \gdef\putwordDefvar{Variable}\fi +\ifx\putwordDefopt\undefined \gdef\putwordDefopt{User Option}\fi +\ifx\putwordDeftypevar\undefined\gdef\putwordDeftypevar{Variable}\fi +\ifx\putwordDeffunc\undefined \gdef\putwordDeffunc{Function}\fi +\ifx\putwordDeftypefun\undefined\gdef\putwordDeftypefun{Function}\fi + +% In some macros, we cannot use the `\? notation---the left quote is +% in some cases the escape char. +\chardef\colonChar = `\: +\chardef\commaChar = `\, +\chardef\dotChar = `\. +\chardef\equalChar = `\= +\chardef\exclamChar= `\! +\chardef\questChar = `\? +\chardef\semiChar = `\; +\chardef\spaceChar = `\ % +\chardef\underChar = `\_ % Ignore a token. % \def\gobble#1{} +% True if #1 is the empty string, i.e., called like `\ifempty{}'. +% +\def\ifempty#1{\ifemptyx #1\emptymarkA\emptymarkB}% +\def\ifemptyx#1#2\emptymarkB{\ifx #1\emptymarkA}% + +% Hyphenation fixes. \hyphenation{ap-pen-dix} -\hyphenation{mini-buf-fer mini-buf-fers} \hyphenation{eshell} +\hyphenation{mini-buf-fer mini-buf-fers} +\hyphenation{time-stamp} +\hyphenation{white-space} % Margin to add to right of even pages, to left of odd pages. -\newdimen \bindingoffset \bindingoffset=0pt -\newdimen \normaloffset \normaloffset=\hoffset +\newdimen\bindingoffset +\newdimen\normaloffset \newdimen\pagewidth \newdimen\pageheight -\pagewidth=\hsize \pageheight=\vsize % Sometimes it is convenient to have everything in the transcript file % and nothing on the terminal. We don't just call \tracingall here, -% since that produces some useless output on the terminal. +% since that produces some useless output on the terminal. We also make +% some effort to order the tracing commands to reduce output in the log +% file; cf. trace.sty in LaTeX. % \def\gloggingall{\begingroup \globaldefs = 1 \loggingall \endgroup}% -\def\loggingall{\tracingcommands2 \tracingstats2 - \tracingpages1 \tracingoutput1 \tracinglostchars1 - \tracingmacros2 \tracingparagraphs1 \tracingrestores1 - \showboxbreadth\maxdimen\showboxdepth\maxdimen +\def\loggingall{% + \tracingstats2 + \tracingpages1 + \tracinglostchars2 % 2 gives us more in etex + \tracingparagraphs1 + \tracingoutput1 + \tracingmacros2 + \tracingrestores1 + \showboxbreadth\maxdimen \showboxdepth\maxdimen + \ifx\eTeXversion\undefined\else % etex gives us more logging + \tracingscantokens1 + \tracingifs1 + \tracinggroups1 + \tracingnesting2 + \tracingassigns1 + \fi + \tracingcommands3 % 3 gives us more in etex + \errorcontextlines\maxdimen }% -%---------------------Begin change----------------------- +% add check for \lastpenalty to plain's definitions. If the last thing +% we did was a \nobreak, we don't want to insert more space. % -%%%% For @cropmarks command. -% Dimensions to add cropmarks at corners Added by P. A. MacKay, 12 Nov. 1986 +\def\smallbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\smallskipamount + \removelastskip\penalty-50\smallskip\fi\fi} +\def\medbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\medskipamount + \removelastskip\penalty-100\medskip\fi\fi} +\def\bigbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\bigskipamount + \removelastskip\penalty-200\bigskip\fi\fi} + +% For @cropmarks command. +% Do @cropmarks to get crop marks. % -\newdimen\cornerlong \newdimen\cornerthick -\newdimen \topandbottommargin -\newdimen \outerhsize \newdimen \outervsize -\cornerlong=1pc\cornerthick=.3pt % These set size of cropmarks -\outerhsize=7in -%\outervsize=9.5in -% Alternative @smallbook page size is 9.25in -\outervsize=9.25in -\topandbottommargin=.75in +\newif\ifcropmarks +\let\cropmarks = \cropmarkstrue % -%---------------------End change----------------------- +% Dimensions to add cropmarks at corners. +% Added by P. A. MacKay, 12 Nov. 1986 +% +\newdimen\outerhsize \newdimen\outervsize % set by the paper size routines +\newdimen\cornerlong \cornerlong=1pc +\newdimen\cornerthick \cornerthick=.3pt +\newdimen\topandbottommargin \topandbottommargin=.75in + +% Main output routine. +\chardef\PAGE = 255 +\output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}} + +\newbox\headlinebox +\newbox\footlinebox % \onepageout takes a vbox as an argument. Note that \pagecontents -% does insertions itself, but you have to call it yourself. -\chardef\PAGE=255 \output={\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}} -\def\onepageout#1{\hoffset=\normaloffset -\ifodd\pageno \advance\hoffset by \bindingoffset -\else \advance\hoffset by -\bindingoffset\fi -{\escapechar=`\\\relax % makes sure backslash is used in output files. -\shipout\vbox{{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makeheadline} \pagebody{#1}% -{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makefootline}}}% -\advancepageno \ifnum\outputpenalty>-20000 \else\dosupereject\fi} - -%%%% For @cropmarks command %%%% - -% Here is a modification of the main output routine for Near East Publications -% This provides right-angle cropmarks at all four corners. -% The contents of the page are centerlined into the cropmarks, -% and any desired binding offset is added as an \hskip on either -% site of the centerlined box. (P. A. MacKay, 12 November, 1986) -% -\def\croppageout#1{\hoffset=0pt % make sure this doesn't mess things up -{\escapechar=`\\\relax % makes sure backslash is used in output files. - \shipout - \vbox to \outervsize{\hsize=\outerhsize - \vbox{\line{\ewtop\hfill\ewtop}} - \nointerlineskip - \line{\vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nstop} - \hfill - \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nstop}} - \vskip \topandbottommargin - \centerline{\ifodd\pageno\hskip\bindingoffset\fi - \vbox{ - {\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makeheadline} - \pagebody{#1} - {\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makefootline}} - \ifodd\pageno\else\hskip\bindingoffset\fi} - \vskip \topandbottommargin plus1fill minus1fill - \boxmaxdepth\cornerthick - \line{\vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nsbot} - \hfill - \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nsbot}} - \nointerlineskip - \vbox{\line{\ewbot\hfill\ewbot}} - }} +% does insertions, but you have to call it yourself. +\def\onepageout#1{% + \ifcropmarks \hoffset=0pt \else \hoffset=\normaloffset \fi + % + \ifodd\pageno \advance\hoffset by \bindingoffset + \else \advance\hoffset by -\bindingoffset\fi + % + % Do this outside of the \shipout so @code etc. will be expanded in + % the headline as they should be, not taken literally (outputting ''code). + \setbox\headlinebox = \vbox{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makeheadline}% + \setbox\footlinebox = \vbox{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makefootline}% + % + {% + % Have to do this stuff outside the \shipout because we want it to + % take effect in \write's, yet the group defined by the \vbox ends + % before the \shipout runs. + % + \escapechar = `\\ % use backslash in output files. + \indexdummies % don't expand commands in the output. + \normalturnoffactive % \ in index entries must not stay \, e.g., if + % the page break happens to be in the middle of an example. + \shipout\vbox{% + % Do this early so pdf references go to the beginning of the page. + \ifpdfmakepagedest \pdfmkdest{\the\pageno}\fi + % + \ifcropmarks \vbox to \outervsize\bgroup + \hsize = \outerhsize + \vskip-\topandbottommargin + \vtop to0pt{% + \line{\ewtop\hfil\ewtop}% + \nointerlineskip + \line{% + \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nstop}% + \hfill + \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nstop}% + }% + \vss}% + \vskip\topandbottommargin + \line\bgroup + \hfil % center the page within the outer (page) hsize. + \ifodd\pageno\hskip\bindingoffset\fi + \vbox\bgroup + \fi + % + \unvbox\headlinebox + \pagebody{#1}% + \ifdim\ht\footlinebox > 0pt + % Only leave this space if the footline is nonempty. + % (We lessened \vsize for it in \oddfootingxxx.) + % The \baselineskip=24pt in plain's \makefootline has no effect. + \vskip 2\baselineskip + \unvbox\footlinebox + \fi + % + \ifcropmarks + \egroup % end of \vbox\bgroup + \hfil\egroup % end of (centering) \line\bgroup + \vskip\topandbottommargin plus1fill minus1fill + \boxmaxdepth = \cornerthick + \vbox to0pt{\vss + \line{% + \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nsbot}% + \hfill + \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nsbot}% + }% + \nointerlineskip + \line{\ewbot\hfil\ewbot}% + }% + \egroup % \vbox from first cropmarks clause + \fi + }% end of \shipout\vbox + }% end of group with \normalturnoffactive \advancepageno - \ifnum\outputpenalty>-20000 \else\dosupereject\fi} -% -% Do @cropmarks to get crop marks -\def\cropmarks{\let\onepageout=\croppageout } + \ifnum\outputpenalty>-20000 \else\dosupereject\fi +} \newinsert\margin \dimen\margin=\maxdimen @@ -194,7 +325,6 @@ \ifr@ggedbottom \kern-\dimen@ \vfil \fi} } -% % Here are the rules for the cropmarks. Note that they are % offset so that the space between them is truly \outerhsize or \outervsize % (P. A. MacKay, 12 November, 1986) @@ -289,11 +419,11 @@ %% Call \inENV within environments (after a \begingroup) \newif\ifENV \ENVfalse \def\inENV{\ifENV\relax\else\ENVtrue\fi} \def\ENVcheck{% -\ifENV\errmessage{Still within an environment. Type Return to continue.} +\ifENV\errmessage{Still within an environment; press RETURN to continue} \endgroup\fi} % This is not perfect, but it should reduce lossage % @begin foo is the same as @foo, for now. -\newhelp\EMsimple{Type to continue.} +\newhelp\EMsimple{Press RETURN to continue.} \outer\def\begin{\parsearg\beginxxx} @@ -337,22 +467,11 @@ } -% Single-spacing is done by various environments (specifically, in -% \nonfillstart and \quotations). -\newskip\singlespaceskip \singlespaceskip = 12.5pt -\def\singlespace{% - % Why was this kern here? It messes up equalizing space above and below - % environments. --karl, 6may93 - %{\advance \baselineskip by -\singlespaceskip - %\kern \baselineskip}% - \setleading \singlespaceskip -} - %% Simple single-character @ commands % @@ prints an @ % Kludge this until the fonts are right (grr). -\def\@{{\tt \char '100}} +\def\@{{\tt\char64}} % This is turned off because it was never documented % and you can use @w{...} around a quote to suppress ligatures. @@ -362,11 +481,58 @@ %\def\'{{'}} % Used to generate quoted braces. - -\def\mylbrace {{\tt \char '173}} -\def\myrbrace {{\tt \char '175}} +\def\mylbrace {{\tt\char123}} +\def\myrbrace {{\tt\char125}} \let\{=\mylbrace \let\}=\myrbrace +\begingroup + % Definitions to produce \{ and \} commands for indices, + % and @{ and @} for the aux file. + \catcode`\{ = \other \catcode`\} = \other + \catcode`\[ = 1 \catcode`\] = 2 + \catcode`\! = 0 \catcode`\\ = \other + !gdef!lbracecmd[\{]% + !gdef!rbracecmd[\}]% + !gdef!lbraceatcmd[@{]% + !gdef!rbraceatcmd[@}]% +!endgroup + +% Accents: @, @dotaccent @ringaccent @ubaraccent @udotaccent +% Others are defined by plain TeX: @` @' @" @^ @~ @= @u @v @H. +\let\, = \c +\let\dotaccent = \. +\def\ringaccent#1{{\accent23 #1}} +\let\tieaccent = \t +\let\ubaraccent = \b +\let\udotaccent = \d + +% Other special characters: @questiondown @exclamdown +% Plain TeX defines: @AA @AE @O @OE @L (plus lowercase versions) @ss. +\def\questiondown{?`} +\def\exclamdown{!`} + +% Dotless i and dotless j, used for accents. +\def\imacro{i} +\def\jmacro{j} +\def\dotless#1{% + \def\temp{#1}% + \ifx\temp\imacro \ptexi + \else\ifx\temp\jmacro \j + \else \errmessage{@dotless can be used only with i or j}% + \fi\fi +} + +% Be sure we're in horizontal mode when doing a tie, since we make space +% equivalent to this in @example-like environments. Otherwise, a space +% at the beginning of a line will start with \penalty -- and +% since \penalty is valid in vertical mode, we'd end up putting the +% penalty on the vertical list instead of in the new paragraph. +{\catcode`@ = 11 + % Avoid using \@M directly, because that causes trouble + % if the definition is written into an index file. + \global\let\tiepenalty = \@M + \gdef\tie{\leavevmode\penalty\tiepenalty\ } +} % @: forces normal size whitespace following. \def\:{\spacefactor=1000 } @@ -374,17 +540,17 @@ % @* forces a line break. \def\*{\hfil\break\hbox{}\ignorespaces} +% @/ allows a line break. +\let\/=\allowbreak + % @. is an end-of-sentence period. \def\.{.\spacefactor=3000 } -% @enddots{} is an end-of-sentence ellipsis. -\gdef\enddots{$\mathinner{\ldotp\ldotp\ldotp\ldotp}$\spacefactor=3000} - % @! is an end-of-sentence bang. -\gdef\!{!\spacefactor=3000 } +\def\!{!\spacefactor=3000 } % @? is an end-of-sentence query. -\gdef\?{?\spacefactor=3000 } +\def\?{?\spacefactor=3000 } % @w prevents a word break. Without the \leavevmode, @w at the % beginning of a paragraph, when TeX is still in vertical mode, would @@ -399,6 +565,16 @@ % therefore, no glue is inserted, and the space between the headline and % the text is small, which looks bad. % +% Another complication is that the group might be very large. This can +% cause the glue on the previous page to be unduly stretched, because it +% does not have much material. In this case, it's better to add an +% explicit \vfill so that the extra space is at the bottom. The +% threshold for doing this is if the group is more than \vfilllimit +% percent of a page (\vfilllimit can be changed inside of @tex). +% +\newbox\groupbox +\def\vfilllimit{0.7} +% \def\group{\begingroup \ifnum\catcode13=\active \else \errhelp = \groupinvalidhelp @@ -412,10 +588,22 @@ % above. But it's pretty close. \def\Egroup{% \egroup % End the \vtop. + % \dimen0 is the vertical size of the group's box. + \dimen0 = \ht\groupbox \advance\dimen0 by \dp\groupbox + % \dimen2 is how much space is left on the page (more or less). + \dimen2 = \pageheight \advance\dimen2 by -\pagetotal + % if the group doesn't fit on the current page, and it's a big big + % group, force a page break. + \ifdim \dimen0 > \dimen2 + \ifdim \pagetotal < \vfilllimit\pageheight + \page + \fi + \fi + \copy\groupbox \endgroup % End the \group. }% % - \vtop\bgroup + \setbox\groupbox = \vtop\bgroup % We have to put a strut on the last line in case the @group is in % the midst of an example, rather than completely enclosing it. % Otherwise, the interline space between the last line of the group @@ -468,53 +656,80 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.} %% This method tries to make TeX break the page naturally %% if the depth of the box does not fit. %{\baselineskip=0pt% -%\vtop to #1\mil{\vfil}\kern -#1\mil\penalty 10000 +%\vtop to #1\mil{\vfil}\kern -#1\mil\nobreak %\prevdepth=-1000pt %}} \def\needx#1{% - % Go into vertical mode, so we don't make a big box in the middle of a + % Ensure vertical mode, so we don't make a big box in the middle of a % paragraph. \par % - % Don't add any leading before our big empty box, but allow a page - % break, since the best break might be right here. - \allowbreak - \nointerlineskip - \vtop to #1\mil{\vfil}% - % - % TeX does not even consider page breaks if a penalty added to the - % main vertical list is 10000 or more. But in order to see if the - % empty box we just added fits on the page, we must make it consider - % page breaks. On the other hand, we don't want to actually break the - % page after the empty box. So we use a penalty of 9999. - % - % There is an extremely small chance that TeX will actually break the - % page at this \penalty, if there are no other feasible breakpoints in - % sight. (If the user is using lots of big @group commands, which - % almost-but-not-quite fill up a page, TeX will have a hard time doing - % good page breaking, for example.) However, I could not construct an - % example where a page broke at this \penalty; if it happens in a real - % document, then we can reconsider our strategy. - \penalty9999 - % - % Back up by the size of the box, whether we did a page break or not. - \kern -#1\mil - % - % Do not allow a page break right after this kern. - \nobreak + % If the @need value is less than one line space, it's useless. + \dimen0 = #1\mil + \dimen2 = \ht\strutbox + \advance\dimen2 by \dp\strutbox + \ifdim\dimen0 > \dimen2 + % + % Do a \strut just to make the height of this box be normal, so the + % normal leading is inserted relative to the preceding line. + % And a page break here is fine. + \vtop to #1\mil{\strut\vfil}% + % + % TeX does not even consider page breaks if a penalty added to the + % main vertical list is 10000 or more. But in order to see if the + % empty box we just added fits on the page, we must make it consider + % page breaks. On the other hand, we don't want to actually break the + % page after the empty box. So we use a penalty of 9999. + % + % There is an extremely small chance that TeX will actually break the + % page at this \penalty, if there are no other feasible breakpoints in + % sight. (If the user is using lots of big @group commands, which + % almost-but-not-quite fill up a page, TeX will have a hard time doing + % good page breaking, for example.) However, I could not construct an + % example where a page broke at this \penalty; if it happens in a real + % document, then we can reconsider our strategy. + \penalty9999 + % + % Back up by the size of the box, whether we did a page break or not. + \kern -#1\mil + % + % Do not allow a page break right after this kern. + \nobreak + \fi } % @br forces paragraph break \let\br = \par -% @dots{} output some dots - -\def\dots{$\ldots$} +% @dots{} output an ellipsis using the current font. +% We do .5em per period so that it has the same spacing in a typewriter +% font as three actual period characters. +% +\def\dots{% + \leavevmode + \hbox to 1.5em{% + \hskip 0pt plus 0.25fil minus 0.25fil + .\hss.\hss.% + \hskip 0pt plus 0.5fil minus 0.5fil + }% +} -% @page forces the start of a new page +% @enddots{} is an end-of-sentence ellipsis. +% +\def\enddots{% + \leavevmode + \hbox to 2em{% + \hskip 0pt plus 0.25fil minus 0.25fil + .\hss.\hss.\hss.% + \hskip 0pt plus 0.5fil minus 0.5fil + }% + \spacefactor=3000 +} +% @page forces the start of a new page. +% \def\page{\par\vfill\supereject} % @exdent text.... @@ -533,396 +748,552 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.} \def\nofillexdentyyy #1{{\advance \leftskip by -\exdentamount \leftline{\hskip\leftskip{\rm#1}}}} -%\hbox{{\rm#1}}\hfil\break}} +% @inmargin{WHICH}{TEXT} puts TEXT in the WHICH margin next to the current +% paragraph. For more general purposes, use the \margin insertion +% class. WHICH is `l' or `r'. +% +\newskip\inmarginspacing \inmarginspacing=1cm +\def\strutdepth{\dp\strutbox} +% +\def\doinmargin#1#2{\strut\vadjust{% + \nobreak + \kern-\strutdepth + \vtop to \strutdepth{% + \baselineskip=\strutdepth + \vss + % if you have multiple lines of stuff to put here, you'll need to + % make the vbox yourself of the appropriate size. + \ifx#1l% + \llap{\ignorespaces #2\hskip\inmarginspacing}% + \else + \rlap{\hskip\hsize \hskip\inmarginspacing \ignorespaces #2}% + \fi + \null + }% +}} +\def\inleftmargin{\doinmargin l} +\def\inrightmargin{\doinmargin r} +% +% @inmargin{TEXT [, RIGHT-TEXT]} +% (if RIGHT-TEXT is given, use TEXT for left page, RIGHT-TEXT for right; +% else use TEXT for both). +% +\def\inmargin#1{\parseinmargin #1,,\finish} +\def\parseinmargin#1,#2,#3\finish{% not perfect, but better than nothing. + \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% + \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt + \def\lefttext{#1}% have both texts + \def\righttext{#2}% + \else + \def\lefttext{#1}% have only one text + \def\righttext{#1}% + \fi + % + \ifodd\pageno + \def\temp{\inrightmargin\righttext}% odd page -> outside is right margin + \else + \def\temp{\inleftmargin\lefttext}% + \fi + \temp +} % @include file insert text of that file as input. - -\def\include{\parsearg\includezzz} -%Use \input\thisfile to avoid blank after \input, which may be an active -%char (in which case the blank would become the \input argument). -%The grouping keeps the value of \thisfile correct even when @include -%is nested. -\def\includezzz #1{\begingroup -\def\thisfile{#1}\input\thisfile +% Allow normal characters that we make active in the argument (a file name). +\def\include{\begingroup + \catcode`\\=\other + \catcode`~=\other + \catcode`^=\other + \catcode`_=\other + \catcode`|=\other + \catcode`<=\other + \catcode`>=\other + \catcode`+=\other + \parsearg\includezzz} +% Restore active chars for included file. +\def\includezzz#1{\endgroup\begingroup + % Read the included file in a group so nested @include's work. + \def\thisfile{#1}% + \let\value=\expandablevalue + \input\thisfile \endgroup} \def\thisfile{} -% @center line outputs that line, centered - -\def\center{\parsearg\centerzzz} -\def\centerzzz #1{{\advance\hsize by -\leftskip -\advance\hsize by -\rightskip -\centerline{#1}}} +% @center line +% outputs that line, centered. +% +\def\center{\parsearg\docenter} +\def\docenter#1{{% + \ifhmode \hfil\break \fi + \advance\hsize by -\leftskip + \advance\hsize by -\rightskip + \line{\hfil \ignorespaces#1\unskip \hfil}% + \ifhmode \break \fi +}} % @sp n outputs n lines of vertical space \def\sp{\parsearg\spxxx} -\def\spxxx #1{\par \vskip #1\baselineskip} +\def\spxxx #1{\vskip #1\baselineskip} % @comment ...line which is ignored... % @c is the same as @comment % @ignore ... @end ignore is another way to write a comment -\def\comment{\catcode 64=\other \catcode 123=\other \catcode 125=\other% -\parsearg \commentxxx} - -\def\commentxxx #1{\catcode 64=0 \catcode 123=1 \catcode 125=2 } +\def\comment{\begingroup \catcode`\^^M=\other% +\catcode`\@=\other \catcode`\{=\other \catcode`\}=\other% +\commentxxx} +{\catcode`\^^M=\other \gdef\commentxxx#1^^M{\endgroup}} \let\c=\comment -% Prevent errors for section commands. -% Used in @ignore and in failing conditionals. -\def\ignoresections{% -\let\chapter=\relax -\let\unnumbered=\relax -\let\top=\relax -\let\unnumberedsec=\relax -\let\unnumberedsection=\relax -\let\unnumberedsubsec=\relax -\let\unnumberedsubsection=\relax -\let\unnumberedsubsubsec=\relax -\let\unnumberedsubsubsection=\relax -\let\section=\relax -\let\subsec=\relax -\let\subsubsec=\relax -\let\subsection=\relax -\let\subsubsection=\relax -\let\appendix=\relax -\let\appendixsec=\relax -\let\appendixsection=\relax -\let\appendixsubsec=\relax -\let\appendixsubsection=\relax -\let\appendixsubsubsec=\relax -\let\appendixsubsubsection=\relax -\let\contents=\relax -\let\smallbook=\relax -\let\titlepage=\relax -} - -% Used in nested conditionals, where we have to parse the Texinfo source -% and so want to turn off most commands, in case they are used -% incorrectly. -% -\def\ignoremorecommands{% - \let\defcv = \relax - \let\deffn = \relax - \let\deffnx = \relax - \let\defindex = \relax - \let\defivar = \relax - \let\defmac = \relax - \let\defmethod = \relax - \let\defop = \relax - \let\defopt = \relax - \let\defspec = \relax - \let\deftp = \relax - \let\deftypefn = \relax - \let\deftypefun = \relax - \let\deftypevar = \relax - \let\deftypevr = \relax - \let\defun = \relax - \let\defvar = \relax - \let\defvr = \relax - \let\ref = \relax - \let\xref = \relax - \let\printindex = \relax - \let\pxref = \relax - \let\settitle = \relax - \let\include = \relax - \let\lowersections = \relax - \let\down = \relax - \let\raisesections = \relax - \let\up = \relax - \let\set = \relax - \let\clear = \relax - \let\item = \relax - \let\message = \relax -} - -% Ignore @ignore ... @end ignore. -% -\def\ignore{\doignore{ignore}} - -% Also ignore @ifinfo, @ifhtml, @html, @menu, and @direntry text. +% @paragraphindent NCHARS +% We'll use ems for NCHARS, close enough. +% NCHARS can also be the word `asis' or `none'. +% We cannot feasibly implement @paragraphindent asis, though. % -\def\ifinfo{\doignore{ifinfo}} -\def\ifhtml{\doignore{ifhtml}} -\def\html{\doignore{html}} -\def\menu{\doignore{menu}} -\def\direntry{\doignore{direntry}} - -% Ignore text until a line `@end #1'. +\def\asisword{asis} % no translation, these are keywords +\def\noneword{none} % -\def\doignore#1{\begingroup - % Don't complain about control sequences we have declared \outer. - \ignoresections - % - % Define a command to swallow text until we reach `@end #1'. - \long\def\doignoretext##1\end #1{\enddoignore}% - % - % Make sure that spaces turn into tokens that match what \doignoretext wants. - \catcode32 = 10 - % - % And now expand that command. - \doignoretext -} - -% What we do to finish off ignored text. -% -\def\enddoignore{\endgroup\ignorespaces}% - -\newif\ifwarnedobs\warnedobsfalse -\def\obstexwarn{% - \ifwarnedobs\relax\else - % We need to warn folks that they may have trouble with TeX 3.0. - % This uses \immediate\write16 rather than \message to get newlines. - \immediate\write16{} - \immediate\write16{***WARNING*** for users of Unix TeX 3.0!} - \immediate\write16{This manual trips a bug in TeX version 3.0 (tex hangs).} - \immediate\write16{If you are running another version of TeX, relax.} - \immediate\write16{If you are running Unix TeX 3.0, kill this TeX process.} - \immediate\write16{ Then upgrade your TeX installation if you can.} - \immediate\write16{If you are stuck with version 3.0, run the} - \immediate\write16{ script ``tex3patch'' from the Texinfo distribution} - \immediate\write16{ to use a workaround.} - \immediate\write16{} - \warnedobstrue +\def\paragraphindent{\parsearg\doparagraphindent} +\def\doparagraphindent#1{% + \def\temp{#1}% + \ifx\temp\asisword + \else + \ifx\temp\noneword + \defaultparindent = 0pt + \else + \defaultparindent = #1em \fi + \fi + \parindent = \defaultparindent } -% **In TeX 3.0, setting text in \nullfont hangs tex. For a -% workaround (which requires the file ``dummy.tfm'' to be installed), -% uncomment the following line: -%%%%%\font\nullfont=dummy\let\obstexwarn=\relax - -% Ignore text, except that we keep track of conditional commands for -% purposes of nesting, up to an `@end #1' command. -% -\def\nestedignore#1{% - \obstexwarn - % We must actually expand the ignored text to look for the @end - % command, so that nested ignore constructs work. Thus, we put the - % text into a \vbox and then do nothing with the result. To minimize - % the change of memory overflow, we follow the approach outlined on - % page 401 of the TeXbook: make the current font be a dummy font. - % - \setbox0 = \vbox\bgroup - % Don't complain about control sequences we have declared \outer. - \ignoresections - % - % Define `@end #1' to end the box, which will in turn undefine the - % @end command again. - \expandafter\def\csname E#1\endcsname{\egroup\ignorespaces}% - % - % We are going to be parsing Texinfo commands. Most cause no - % trouble when they are used incorrectly, but some commands do - % complicated argument parsing or otherwise get confused, so we - % undefine them. - % - % We can't do anything about stray @-signs, unfortunately; - % they'll produce `undefined control sequence' errors. - \ignoremorecommands - % - % Set the current font to be \nullfont, a TeX primitive, and define - % all the font commands to also use \nullfont. We don't use - % dummy.tfm, as suggested in the TeXbook, because not all sites - % might have that installed. Therefore, math mode will still - % produce output, but that should be an extremely small amount of - % stuff compared to the main input. - % - \nullfont - \let\tenrm = \nullfont \let\tenit = \nullfont \let\tensl = \nullfont - \let\tenbf = \nullfont \let\tentt = \nullfont \let\smallcaps = \nullfont - \let\tensf = \nullfont - % Similarly for index fonts (mostly for their use in - % smallexample) - \let\indrm = \nullfont \let\indit = \nullfont \let\indsl = \nullfont - \let\indbf = \nullfont \let\indtt = \nullfont \let\indsc = \nullfont - \let\indsf = \nullfont - % - % Don't complain when characters are missing from the fonts. - \tracinglostchars = 0 - % - % Don't bother to do space factor calculations. - \frenchspacing - % - % Don't report underfull hboxes. - \hbadness = 10000 - % - % Do minimal line-breaking. - \pretolerance = 10000 - % - % Do not execute instructions in @tex - \def\tex{\doignore{tex}} -} - -% @set VAR sets the variable VAR to an empty value. -% @set VAR REST-OF-LINE sets VAR to the value REST-OF-LINE. -% -% Since we want to separate VAR from REST-OF-LINE (which might be -% empty), we can't just use \parsearg; we have to insert a space of our -% own to delimit the rest of the line, and then take it out again if we -% didn't need it. -% -\def\set{\parsearg\setxxx} -\def\setxxx#1{\setyyy#1 \endsetyyy} -\def\setyyy#1 #2\endsetyyy{% - \def\temp{#2}% - \ifx\temp\empty \global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname = \empty - \else \setzzz{#1}#2\endsetzzz % Remove the trailing space \setxxx inserted. +% @exampleindent NCHARS +% We'll use ems for NCHARS like @paragraphindent. +% It seems @exampleindent asis isn't necessary, but +% I preserve it to make it similar to @paragraphindent. +\def\exampleindent{\parsearg\doexampleindent} +\def\doexampleindent#1{% + \def\temp{#1}% + \ifx\temp\asisword + \else + \ifx\temp\noneword + \lispnarrowing = 0pt + \else + \lispnarrowing = #1em + \fi \fi } -% Can't use \xdef to pre-expand #2 and save some time, since \temp or -% \next or other control sequences that we've defined might get us into -% an infinite loop. Consider `@set foo @cite{bar}'. -\def\setzzz#1#2 \endsetzzz{\expandafter\gdef\csname SET#1\endcsname{#2}} -% @clear VAR clears (i.e., unsets) the variable VAR. +% @firstparagraphindent WORD +% If WORD is `none', then suppress indentation of the first paragraph +% after a section heading. If WORD is `insert', then do indent at such +% paragraphs. % -\def\clear{\parsearg\clearxxx} -\def\clearxxx#1{\global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname=\relax} - -% @value{foo} gets the text saved in variable foo. +% The paragraph indentation is suppressed or not by calling +% \suppressfirstparagraphindent, which the sectioning commands do. +% We switch the definition of this back and forth according to WORD. +% By default, we suppress indentation. % -\def\value#1{\expandafter - \ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax - {\{No value for ``#1''\}} - \else \csname SET#1\endcsname \fi} - -% @ifset VAR ... @end ifset reads the `...' iff VAR has been defined -% with @set. +\def\suppressfirstparagraphindent{\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent} +\newdimen\currentparindent % -\def\ifset{\parsearg\ifsetxxx} -\def\ifsetxxx #1{% - \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax - \expandafter\ifsetfail - \else - \expandafter\ifsetsucceed - \fi -} -\def\ifsetsucceed{\conditionalsucceed{ifset}} -\def\ifsetfail{\nestedignore{ifset}} -\defineunmatchedend{ifset} - -% @ifclear VAR ... @end ifclear reads the `...' iff VAR has never been -% defined with @set, or has been undefined with @clear. +\def\insertword{insert} % -\def\ifclear{\parsearg\ifclearxxx} -\def\ifclearxxx #1{% - \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax - \expandafter\ifclearsucceed +\def\firstparagraphindent{\parsearg\dofirstparagraphindent} +\def\dofirstparagraphindent#1{% + \def\temp{#1}% + \ifx\temp\noneword + \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \dosuppressfirstparagraphindent + \else\ifx\temp\insertword + \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \relax \else - \expandafter\ifclearfail - \fi + \errhelp = \EMsimple + \errmessage{Unknown @firstparagraphindent option `\temp'}% + \fi\fi } -\def\ifclearsucceed{\conditionalsucceed{ifclear}} -\def\ifclearfail{\nestedignore{ifclear}} -\defineunmatchedend{ifclear} -% @iftex always succeeds; we read the text following, through @end -% iftex). But `@end iftex' should be valid only after an @iftex. +% Here is how we actually suppress indentation. Redefine \everypar to +% \kern backwards by \parindent, and then reset itself to empty. % -\def\iftex{\conditionalsucceed{iftex}} -\defineunmatchedend{iftex} - -% We can't just want to start a group at @iftex (for example) and end it -% at @end iftex, since then @set commands inside the conditional have no -% effect (they'd get reverted at the end of the group). So we must -% define \Eiftex to redefine itself to be its previous value. (We can't -% just define it to fail again with an ``unmatched end'' error, since -% the @ifset might be nested.) +% We also make \indent itself not actually do anything until the next +% paragraph. % -\def\conditionalsucceed#1{% - \edef\temp{% - % Remember the current value of \E#1. - \let\nece{prevE#1} = \nece{E#1}% - % - % At the `@end #1', redefine \E#1 to be its previous value. - \def\nece{E#1}{\let\nece{E#1} = \nece{prevE#1}}% +\gdef\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent{% + \gdef\indent{% + \restorefirstparagraphindent + \indent + }% + \gdef\noindent{% + \restorefirstparagraphindent + \noindent + }% + \global\everypar = {% + \kern -\parindent + \restorefirstparagraphindent }% - \temp } -% We need to expand lots of \csname's, but we don't want to expand the -% control sequences after we've constructed them. -% -\def\nece#1{\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname} +\gdef\restorefirstparagraphindent{% + \global \let \indent = \ptexindent + \global \let \noindent = \ptexnoindent + \global \everypar = {}% +} + % @asis just yields its argument. Used with @table, for example. % \def\asis#1{#1} -% @math means output in math mode. -% We don't use $'s directly in the definition of \math because control -% sequences like \math are expanded when the toc file is written. Then, -% we read the toc file back, the $'s will be normal characters (as they -% should be, according to the definition of Texinfo). So we must use a -% control sequence to switch into and out of math mode. +% @math outputs its argument in math mode. +% We don't use $'s directly in the definition of \math because we need +% to set catcodes according to plain TeX first, to allow for subscripts, +% superscripts, special math chars, etc. +% +\let\implicitmath = $%$ font-lock fix +% +% One complication: _ usually means subscripts, but it could also mean +% an actual _ character, as in @math{@var{some_variable} + 1}. So make +% _ within @math be active (mathcode "8000), and distinguish by seeing +% if the current family is \slfam, which is what @var uses. +% +{\catcode\underChar = \active +\gdef\mathunderscore{% + \catcode\underChar=\active + \def_{\ifnum\fam=\slfam \_\else\sb\fi}% +}} +% +% Another complication: we want \\ (and @\) to output a \ character. +% FYI, plain.tex uses \\ as a temporary control sequence (why?), but +% this is not advertised and we don't care. Texinfo does not +% otherwise define @\. % -% This isn't quite enough for @math to work properly in indices, but it -% seems unlikely it will ever be needed there. +% The \mathchar is class=0=ordinary, family=7=ttfam, position=5C=\. +\def\mathbackslash{\ifnum\fam=\ttfam \mathchar"075C \else\backslash \fi} +% +\def\math{% + \tex + \mathcode`\_="8000 \mathunderscore + \let\\ = \mathbackslash + \mathactive + \implicitmath\finishmath} +\def\finishmath#1{#1\implicitmath\Etex} + +% Some active characters (such as <) are spaced differently in math. +% We have to reset their definitions in case the @math was an +% argument to a command which set the catcodes (such as @item or @section). % -\let\implicitmath = $ -\def\math#1{\implicitmath #1\implicitmath} +{ + \catcode`^ = \active + \catcode`< = \active + \catcode`> = \active + \catcode`+ = \active + \gdef\mathactive{% + \let^ = \ptexhat + \let< = \ptexless + \let> = \ptexgtr + \let+ = \ptexplus + } +} % @bullet and @minus need the same treatment as @math, just above. \def\bullet{\implicitmath\ptexbullet\implicitmath} \def\minus{\implicitmath-\implicitmath} -\def\node{\ENVcheck\parsearg\nodezzz} -\def\nodezzz#1{\nodexxx [#1,]} -\def\nodexxx[#1,#2]{\gdef\lastnode{#1}} -\let\nwnode=\node -\let\lastnode=\relax - -\def\donoderef{\ifx\lastnode\relax\else -\expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\setref{\lastnode}\fi -\global\let\lastnode=\relax} - -\def\unnumbnoderef{\ifx\lastnode\relax\else -\expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\unnumbsetref{\lastnode}\fi -\global\let\lastnode=\relax} - -\def\appendixnoderef{\ifx\lastnode\relax\else -\expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\appendixsetref{\lastnode}\fi -\global\let\lastnode=\relax} - +% @refill is a no-op. \let\refill=\relax +% If working on a large document in chapters, it is convenient to +% be able to disable indexing, cross-referencing, and contents, for test runs. +% This is done with @novalidate (before @setfilename). +% +\newif\iflinks \linkstrue % by default we want the aux files. +\let\novalidate = \linksfalse + % @setfilename is done at the beginning of every texinfo file. % So open here the files we need to have open while reading the input. % This makes it possible to make a .fmt file for texinfo. \def\setfilename{% - \readauxfile - \opencontents + \iflinks + \readauxfile + \fi % \openindices needs to do some work in any case. \openindices \fixbackslash % Turn off hack to swallow `\input texinfo'. \global\let\setfilename=\comment % Ignore extra @setfilename cmds. + % + % If texinfo.cnf is present on the system, read it. + % Useful for site-wide @afourpaper, etc. + % Just to be on the safe side, close the input stream before the \input. + \openin 1 texinfo.cnf + \ifeof1 \let\temp=\relax \else \def\temp{\input texinfo.cnf }\fi + \closein1 + \temp + % \comment % Ignore the actual filename. } -\outer\def\bye{\pagealignmacro\tracingstats=1\ptexend} - -\def\inforef #1{\inforefzzz #1,,,,**} -\def\inforefzzz #1,#2,#3,#4**{\putwordSee{} \putwordInfo{} \putwordfile{} \file{\ignorespaces #3{}}, - node \samp{\ignorespaces#1{}}} +% Called from \setfilename. +% +\def\openindices{% + \newindex{cp}% + \newcodeindex{fn}% + \newcodeindex{vr}% + \newcodeindex{tp}% + \newcodeindex{ky}% + \newcodeindex{pg}% +} -\message{fonts,} +% @bye. +\outer\def\bye{\pagealignmacro\tracingstats=1\ptexend} -% Font-change commands. -% Texinfo supports the sans serif font style, which plain TeX does not. -% So we set up a \sf analogous to plain's \rm, etc. +\message{pdf,} +% adobe `portable' document format +\newcount\tempnum +\newcount\lnkcount +\newtoks\filename +\newcount\filenamelength +\newcount\pgn +\newtoks\toksA +\newtoks\toksB +\newtoks\toksC +\newtoks\toksD +\newbox\boxA +\newcount\countA +\newif\ifpdf +\newif\ifpdfmakepagedest + +\ifx\pdfoutput\undefined + \pdffalse + \let\pdfmkdest = \gobble + \let\pdfurl = \gobble + \let\endlink = \relax + \let\linkcolor = \relax + \let\pdfmakeoutlines = \relax +\else + \pdftrue + \pdfoutput = 1 + \input pdfcolor + \pdfcatalog{/PageMode /UseOutlines}% + \def\dopdfimage#1#2#3{% + \def\imagewidth{#2}% + \def\imageheight{#3}% + % without \immediate, pdftex seg faults when the same image is + % included twice. (Version 3.14159-pre-1.0-unofficial-20010704.) + \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 + \immediate\pdfimage + \else + \immediate\pdfximage + \fi + \ifx\empty\imagewidth\else width \imagewidth \fi + \ifx\empty\imageheight\else height \imageheight \fi + \ifnum\pdftexversion<13 + #1.pdf% + \else + {#1.pdf}% + \fi + \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 \else + \pdfrefximage \pdflastximage + \fi} + \def\pdfmkdest#1{{\normalturnoffactive \pdfdest name{#1} xyz}} + \def\pdfmkpgn#1{#1} + \let\linkcolor = \Blue % was Cyan, but that seems light? + \def\endlink{\Black\pdfendlink} + % Adding outlines to PDF; macros for calculating structure of outlines + % come from Petr Olsak + \def\expnumber#1{\expandafter\ifx\csname#1\endcsname\relax 0% + \else \csname#1\endcsname \fi} + \def\advancenumber#1{\tempnum=\expnumber{#1}\relax + \advance\tempnum by 1 + \expandafter\xdef\csname#1\endcsname{\the\tempnum}} + % + % #1 is the section text. #2 is the pdf expression for the number + % of subentries (or empty, for subsubsections). #3 is the node + % text, which might be empty if this toc entry had no + % corresponding node. #4 is the page number. + % + \def\dopdfoutline#1#2#3#4{% + % Generate a link to the node text if that exists; else, use the + % page number. We could generate a destination for the section + % text in the case where a section has no node, but it doesn't + % seem worthwhile, since most documents are normally structured. + \def\pdfoutlinedest{#3}% + \ifx\pdfoutlinedest\empty \def\pdfoutlinedest{#4}\fi + % + \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfoutlinedest}}#2{#1}% + } + % + \def\pdfmakeoutlines{% + \openin 1 \jobname.toc + \ifeof 1\else\begingroup + \closein 1 + % Thanh's hack / proper braces in bookmarks + \edef\mylbrace{\iftrue \string{\else}\fi}\let\{=\mylbrace + \edef\myrbrace{\iffalse{\else\string}\fi}\let\}=\myrbrace + % + % Read toc silently, to get counts of subentries for \pdfoutline. + \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{\def\thischapnum{##2}}% + \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{% + \def\thissecnum{##2}% + \advancenumber{chap\thischapnum}}% + \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% + \def\thissubsecnum{##2}% + \advancenumber{sec\thissecnum}}% + \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{\advancenumber{subsec\thissubsecnum}}% + % + % use \def rather than \let here because we redefine \chapentry et + % al. a second time, below. + \def\appentry{\numchapentry}% + \def\appsecentry{\numsecentry}% + \def\appsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}% + \def\appsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}% + \def\unnchapentry{\numchapentry}% + \def\unnsecentry{\numsecentry}% + \def\unnsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}% + \def\unnsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}% + \input \jobname.toc + % + % Read toc second time, this time actually producing the outlines. + % The `-' means take the \expnumber as the absolute number of + % subentries, which we calculated on our first read of the .toc above. + % + % We use the node names as the destinations. + \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{% + \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{chap##2}}{##3}{##4}}% + \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{% + \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{sec##2}}{##3}{##4}}% + \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% + \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{subsec##2}}{##3}{##4}}% + \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% count is always zero + \dopdfoutline{##1}{}{##3}{##4}}% + % + % Make special characters normal for writing to the pdf file. + \indexnofonts + \turnoffactive + \input \jobname.toc + \endgroup\fi + } + % + \def\makelinks #1,{% + \def\params{#1}\def\E{END}% + \ifx\params\E + \let\nextmakelinks=\relax + \else + \let\nextmakelinks=\makelinks + \ifnum\lnkcount>0,\fi + \picknum{#1}% + \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]} + goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\the\pgn}}% + \linkcolor #1% + \advance\lnkcount by 1% + \endlink + \fi + \nextmakelinks + } + \def\picknum#1{\expandafter\pn#1} + \def\pn#1{% + \def\p{#1}% + \ifx\p\lbrace + \let\nextpn=\ppn + \else + \let\nextpn=\ppnn + \def\first{#1} + \fi + \nextpn + } + \def\ppn#1{\pgn=#1\gobble} + \def\ppnn{\pgn=\first} + \def\pdfmklnk#1{\lnkcount=0\makelinks #1,END,} + \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1={\the#1#2}}\addtoks} + \def\skipspaces#1{\def\PP{#1}\def\D{|}% + \ifx\PP\D\let\nextsp\relax + \else\let\nextsp\skipspaces + \ifx\p\space\else\addtokens{\filename}{\PP}% + \advance\filenamelength by 1 + \fi + \fi + \nextsp} + \def\getfilename#1{\filenamelength=0\expandafter\skipspaces#1|\relax} + \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 + \let \startlink \pdfannotlink + \else + \let \startlink \pdfstartlink + \fi + \def\pdfurl#1{% + \begingroup + \normalturnoffactive\def\@{@}% + \let\value=\expandablevalue + \leavevmode\Red + \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}% + user{/Subtype /Link /A << /S /URI /URI (#1) >>}% + % #1 + \endgroup} + \def\pdfgettoks#1.{\setbox\boxA=\hbox{\toksA={#1.}\toksB={}\maketoks}} + \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1={\the#1#2}}\addtoks} + \def\adn#1{\addtokens{\toksC}{#1}\global\countA=1\let\next=\maketoks} + \def\poptoks#1#2|ENDTOKS|{\let\first=#1\toksD={#1}\toksA={#2}} + \def\maketoks{% + \expandafter\poptoks\the\toksA|ENDTOKS| + \ifx\first0\adn0 + \else\ifx\first1\adn1 \else\ifx\first2\adn2 \else\ifx\first3\adn3 + \else\ifx\first4\adn4 \else\ifx\first5\adn5 \else\ifx\first6\adn6 + \else\ifx\first7\adn7 \else\ifx\first8\adn8 \else\ifx\first9\adn9 + \else + \ifnum0=\countA\else\makelink\fi + \ifx\first.\let\next=\done\else + \let\next=\maketoks + \addtokens{\toksB}{\the\toksD} + \ifx\first,\addtokens{\toksB}{\space}\fi + \fi + \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi + \next} + \def\makelink{\addtokens{\toksB}% + {\noexpand\pdflink{\the\toksC}}\toksC={}\global\countA=0} + \def\pdflink#1{% + \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]} goto name{\pdfmkpgn{#1}} + \linkcolor #1\endlink} + \def\done{\edef\st{\global\noexpand\toksA={\the\toksB}}\st} +\fi % \ifx\pdfoutput + + +\message{fonts,} +% Font-change commands. + +% Texinfo sort of supports the sans serif font style, which plain TeX does not. +% So we set up a \sf analogous to plain's \rm, etc. \newfam\sffam \def\sf{\fam=\sffam \tensf} \let\li = \sf % Sometimes we call it \li, not \sf. -%% Try out Computer Modern fonts at \magstephalf -\let\mainmagstep=\magstephalf +% We don't need math for this one. +\def\ttsl{\tenttsl} + +% Default leading. +\newdimen\textleading \textleading = 13.2pt + +% Set the baselineskip to #1, and the lineskip and strut size +% correspondingly. There is no deep meaning behind these magic numbers +% used as factors; they just match (closely enough) what Knuth defined. +% +\def\lineskipfactor{.08333} +\def\strutheightpercent{.70833} +\def\strutdepthpercent {.29167} +% +\def\setleading#1{% + \normalbaselineskip = #1\relax + \normallineskip = \lineskipfactor\normalbaselineskip + \normalbaselines + \setbox\strutbox =\hbox{% + \vrule width0pt height\strutheightpercent\baselineskip + depth \strutdepthpercent \baselineskip + }% +} % Set the font macro #1 to the font named #2, adding on the % specified font prefix (normally `cm'). -\def\setfont#1#2{\font#1=\fontprefix#2} +% #3 is the font's design size, #4 is a scale factor +\def\setfont#1#2#3#4{\font#1=\fontprefix#2#3 scaled #4} % Use cm as the default font prefix. % To specify the font prefix, you must define \fontprefix @@ -930,168 +1301,238 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.} \ifx\fontprefix\undefined \def\fontprefix{cm} \fi - +% Support font families that don't use the same naming scheme as CM. +\def\rmshape{r} +\def\rmbshape{bx} %where the normal face is bold +\def\bfshape{b} +\def\bxshape{bx} +\def\ttshape{tt} +\def\ttbshape{tt} +\def\ttslshape{sltt} +\def\itshape{ti} +\def\itbshape{bxti} +\def\slshape{sl} +\def\slbshape{bxsl} +\def\sfshape{ss} +\def\sfbshape{ss} +\def\scshape{csc} +\def\scbshape{csc} + +\newcount\mainmagstep \ifx\bigger\relax -\let\mainmagstep=\magstep1 -\setfont\textrm{r12} -\setfont\texttt{tt12} + % not really supported. + \mainmagstep=\magstep1 + \setfont\textrm\rmshape{12}{1000} + \setfont\texttt\ttshape{12}{1000} \else -\setfont\textrm{r10 scaled \mainmagstep} -\setfont\texttt{tt10 scaled \mainmagstep} + \mainmagstep=\magstephalf + \setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep} + \setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep} \fi -% Instead of cmb10, you many want to use cmbx10. +% Instead of cmb10, you may want to use cmbx10. % cmbx10 is a prettier font on its own, but cmb10 -% looks better when embedded in a line with cmr10. -\setfont\textbf{b10 scaled \mainmagstep} -\setfont\textit{ti10 scaled \mainmagstep} -\setfont\textsl{sl10 scaled \mainmagstep} -\setfont\textsf{ss10 scaled \mainmagstep} -\setfont\textsc{csc10 scaled \mainmagstep} +% looks better when embedded in a line with cmr10 +% (in Bob's opinion). +\setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep} +\setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep} +\setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep} +\setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep} +\setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep} +\setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep} \font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep \font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep % A few fonts for @defun, etc. -\setfont\defbf{bx10 scaled \magstep1} %was 1314 -\setfont\deftt{tt10 scaled \magstep1} +\setfont\defbf\bxshape{10}{\magstep1} %was 1314 +\setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstep1} \def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf \bf} -% Fonts for indices and small examples. -% We actually use the slanted font rather than the italic, -% because texinfo normally uses the slanted fonts for that. -% Do not make many font distinctions in general in the index, since they -% aren't very useful. -\setfont\ninett{tt9} -\setfont\indrm{r9} -\setfont\indit{sl9} -\let\indsl=\indit -\let\indtt=\ninett -\let\indsf=\indrm -\let\indbf=\indrm -\setfont\indsc{csc10 at 9pt} -\font\indi=cmmi9 -\font\indsy=cmsy9 - -% Fonts for headings -\setfont\chaprm{bx12 scaled \magstep2} -\setfont\chapit{ti12 scaled \magstep2} -\setfont\chapsl{sl12 scaled \magstep2} -\setfont\chaptt{tt12 scaled \magstep2} -\setfont\chapsf{ss12 scaled \magstep2} +% Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt). +\setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000} +\setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000} +\setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900} +\setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000} +\setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000} +\setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000} +\setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900} +\setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900} +\font\smalli=cmmi9 +\font\smallsy=cmsy9 + +% Fonts for small examples (8pt). +\setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000} +\setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000} +\setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800} +\setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000} +\setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000} +\setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000} +\setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800} +\setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800} +\font\smalleri=cmmi8 +\font\smallersy=cmsy8 + +% Fonts for title page: +\setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3} +\setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4} +\setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4} +\setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3} +\setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4} +\setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1} +\let\titlebf=\titlerm +\setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4} +\font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3 +\font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4 +\def\authorrm{\secrm} +\def\authortt{\sectt} + +% Chapter (and unnumbered) fonts (17.28pt). +\setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep2} +\setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep3} +\setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep3} +\setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep2} +\setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep3} +\setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{17}{1000} \let\chapbf=\chaprm -\setfont\chapsc{csc10 scaled\magstep3} +\setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep3} \font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep2 \font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep3 -\setfont\secrm{bx12 scaled \magstep1} -\setfont\secit{ti12 scaled \magstep1} -\setfont\secsl{sl12 scaled \magstep1} -\setfont\sectt{tt12 scaled \magstep1} -\setfont\secsf{ss12 scaled \magstep1} -\setfont\secbf{bx12 scaled \magstep1} -\setfont\secsc{csc10 scaled\magstep2} +% Section fonts (14.4pt). +\setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1} +\setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2} +\setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2} +\setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1} +\setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2} +\setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1} +\let\secbf\secrm +\setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2} \font\seci=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1 \font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2 -% \setfont\ssecrm{bx10 scaled \magstep1} % This size an font looked bad. -% \setfont\ssecit{cmti10 scaled \magstep1} % The letters were too crowded. -% \setfont\ssecsl{sl10 scaled \magstep1} -% \setfont\ssectt{tt10 scaled \magstep1} -% \setfont\ssecsf{ss10 scaled \magstep1} - -%\setfont\ssecrm{b10 scaled 1315} % Note the use of cmb rather than cmbx. -%\setfont\ssecit{ti10 scaled 1315} % Also, the size is a little larger than -%\setfont\ssecsl{sl10 scaled 1315} % being scaled magstep1. -%\setfont\ssectt{tt10 scaled 1315} -%\setfont\ssecsf{ss10 scaled 1315} - -%\let\ssecbf=\ssecrm - -\setfont\ssecrm{bx12 scaled \magstephalf} -\setfont\ssecit{ti12 scaled \magstephalf} -\setfont\ssecsl{sl12 scaled \magstephalf} -\setfont\ssectt{tt12 scaled \magstephalf} -\setfont\ssecsf{ss12 scaled \magstephalf} -\setfont\ssecbf{bx12 scaled \magstephalf} -\setfont\ssecsc{csc10 scaled \magstep1} +% Subsection fonts (13.15pt). +\setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstephalf} +\setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1315} +\setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1315} +\setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstephalf} +\setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1315} +\setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstephalf} +\let\ssecbf\ssecrm +\setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep1} \font\sseci=cmmi12 scaled \magstephalf -\font\ssecsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep1 +\font\ssecsy=cmsy10 scaled 1315 % The smallcaps and symbol fonts should actually be scaled \magstep1.5, % but that is not a standard magnification. -% Fonts for title page: -\setfont\titlerm{bx12 scaled \magstep3} -\let\authorrm = \secrm - % In order for the font changes to affect most math symbols and letters, % we have to define the \textfont of the standard families. Since -% texinfo doesn't allow for producing subscripts and superscripts, we -% don't bother to reset \scriptfont and \scriptscriptfont (which would -% also require loading a lot more fonts). +% texinfo doesn't allow for producing subscripts and superscripts except +% in the main text, we don't bother to reset \scriptfont and +% \scriptscriptfont (which would also require loading a lot more fonts). % \def\resetmathfonts{% - \textfont0 = \tenrm \textfont1 = \teni \textfont2 = \tensy - \textfont\itfam = \tenit \textfont\slfam = \tensl \textfont\bffam = \tenbf - \textfont\ttfam = \tentt \textfont\sffam = \tensf + \textfont0=\tenrm \textfont1=\teni \textfont2=\tensy + \textfont\itfam=\tenit \textfont\slfam=\tensl \textfont\bffam=\tenbf + \textfont\ttfam=\tentt \textfont\sffam=\tensf } - % The font-changing commands redefine the meanings of \tenSTYLE, instead % of just \STYLE. We do this so that font changes will continue to work % in math mode, where it is the current \fam that is relevant in most -% cases, not the current. Plain TeX does, for example, -% \def\bf{\fam=\bffam \tenbf} By redefining \tenbf, we obviate the need -% to redefine \bf itself. +% cases, not the current font. Plain TeX does \def\bf{\fam=\bffam +% \tenbf}, for example. By redefining \tenbf, we obviate the need to +% redefine \bf itself. \def\textfonts{% \let\tenrm=\textrm \let\tenit=\textit \let\tensl=\textsl \let\tenbf=\textbf \let\tentt=\texttt \let\smallcaps=\textsc - \let\tensf=\textsf \let\teni=\texti \let\tensy=\textsy - \resetmathfonts} + \let\tensf=\textsf \let\teni=\texti \let\tensy=\textsy \let\tenttsl=\textttsl + \resetmathfonts \setleading{\textleading}} +\def\titlefonts{% + \let\tenrm=\titlerm \let\tenit=\titleit \let\tensl=\titlesl + \let\tenbf=\titlebf \let\tentt=\titlett \let\smallcaps=\titlesc + \let\tensf=\titlesf \let\teni=\titlei \let\tensy=\titlesy + \let\tenttsl=\titlettsl + \resetmathfonts \setleading{25pt}} +\def\titlefont#1{{\titlefonts\rm #1}} \def\chapfonts{% \let\tenrm=\chaprm \let\tenit=\chapit \let\tensl=\chapsl \let\tenbf=\chapbf \let\tentt=\chaptt \let\smallcaps=\chapsc - \let\tensf=\chapsf \let\teni=\chapi \let\tensy=\chapsy - \resetmathfonts} + \let\tensf=\chapsf \let\teni=\chapi \let\tensy=\chapsy \let\tenttsl=\chapttsl + \resetmathfonts \setleading{19pt}} \def\secfonts{% \let\tenrm=\secrm \let\tenit=\secit \let\tensl=\secsl \let\tenbf=\secbf \let\tentt=\sectt \let\smallcaps=\secsc - \let\tensf=\secsf \let\teni=\seci \let\tensy=\secsy - \resetmathfonts} + \let\tensf=\secsf \let\teni=\seci \let\tensy=\secsy \let\tenttsl=\secttsl + \resetmathfonts \setleading{16pt}} \def\subsecfonts{% \let\tenrm=\ssecrm \let\tenit=\ssecit \let\tensl=\ssecsl \let\tenbf=\ssecbf \let\tentt=\ssectt \let\smallcaps=\ssecsc - \let\tensf=\ssecsf \let\teni=\sseci \let\tensy=\ssecsy - \resetmathfonts} -\def\indexfonts{% - \let\tenrm=\indrm \let\tenit=\indit \let\tensl=\indsl - \let\tenbf=\indbf \let\tentt=\indtt \let\smallcaps=\indsc - \let\tensf=\indsf \let\teni=\indi \let\tensy=\indsy - \resetmathfonts} + \let\tensf=\ssecsf \let\teni=\sseci \let\tensy=\ssecsy \let\tenttsl=\ssecttsl + \resetmathfonts \setleading{15pt}} +\let\subsubsecfonts = \subsecfonts % Maybe make sssec fonts scaled magstephalf? +\def\smallfonts{% + \let\tenrm=\smallrm \let\tenit=\smallit \let\tensl=\smallsl + \let\tenbf=\smallbf \let\tentt=\smalltt \let\smallcaps=\smallsc + \let\tensf=\smallsf \let\teni=\smalli \let\tensy=\smallsy + \let\tenttsl=\smallttsl + \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt}} +\def\smallerfonts{% + \let\tenrm=\smallerrm \let\tenit=\smallerit \let\tensl=\smallersl + \let\tenbf=\smallerbf \let\tentt=\smallertt \let\smallcaps=\smallersc + \let\tensf=\smallersf \let\teni=\smalleri \let\tensy=\smallersy + \let\tenttsl=\smallerttsl + \resetmathfonts \setleading{9.5pt}} + +% Set the fonts to use with the @small... environments. +\let\smallexamplefonts = \smallfonts + +% About \smallexamplefonts. If we use \smallfonts (9pt), @smallexample +% can fit this many characters: +% 8.5x11=86 smallbook=72 a4=90 a5=69 +% If we use \smallerfonts (8pt), then we can fit this many characters: +% 8.5x11=90+ smallbook=80 a4=90+ a5=77 +% For me, subjectively, the few extra characters that fit aren't worth +% the additional smallness of 8pt. So I'm making the default 9pt. +% +% By the way, for comparison, here's what fits with @example (10pt): +% 8.5x11=71 smallbook=60 a4=75 a5=58 +% +% I wish we used A4 paper on this side of the Atlantic. +% +% --karl, 24jan03. + % Set up the default fonts, so we can use them for creating boxes. % \textfonts +% Define these so they can be easily changed for other fonts. +\def\angleleft{$\langle$} +\def\angleright{$\rangle$} + % Count depth in font-changes, for error checks \newcount\fontdepth \fontdepth=0 % Fonts for short table of contents. -\setfont\shortcontrm{r12} -\setfont\shortcontbf{bx12} -\setfont\shortcontsl{sl12} +\setfont\shortcontrm\rmshape{12}{1000} +\setfont\shortcontbf\bxshape{12}{1000} +\setfont\shortcontsl\slshape{12}{1000} +\setfont\shortconttt\ttshape{12}{1000} %% Add scribe-like font environments, plus @l for inline lisp (usually sans %% serif) and @ii for TeX italic % \smartitalic{ARG} outputs arg in italics, followed by an italic correction % unless the following character is such as not to need one. -\def\smartitalicx{\ifx\next,\else\ifx\next-\else\ifx\next.\else\/\fi\fi\fi} -\def\smartitalic#1{{\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx} +\def\smartitalicx{\ifx\next,\else\ifx\next-\else\ifx\next.\else + \ptexslash\fi\fi\fi} +\def\smartslanted#1{{\ifusingtt\ttsl\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx} +\def\smartitalic#1{{\ifusingtt\ttsl\it #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx} \let\i=\smartitalic -\let\var=\smartitalic -\let\dfn=\smartitalic +\let\var=\smartslanted +\let\dfn=\smartslanted \let\emph=\smartitalic -\let\cite=\smartitalic +\let\cite=\smartslanted \def\b#1{{\bf #1}} \let\strong=\b @@ -1103,17 +1544,38 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.} \def\nohyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = -1 \aftergroup\restorehyphenation} \def\restorehyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = `- } +% Set sfcode to normal for the chars that usually have another value. +% Can't use plain's \frenchspacing because it uses the `\x notation, and +% sometimes \x has an active definition that messes things up. +% +\catcode`@=11 + \def\frenchspacing{% + \sfcode\dotChar =\@m \sfcode\questChar=\@m \sfcode\exclamChar=\@m + \sfcode\colonChar=\@m \sfcode\semiChar =\@m \sfcode\commaChar =\@m + } +\catcode`@=\other + \def\t#1{% - {\tt \nohyphenation \rawbackslash \frenchspacing #1}% + {\tt \rawbackslash \frenchspacing #1}% \null } -\let\ttfont = \t -%\def\samp #1{`{\tt \rawbackslash \frenchspacing #1}'\null} -\def\samp #1{`\tclose{#1}'\null} -\def\key #1{{\tt \nohyphenation \uppercase{#1}}\null} +\let\ttfont=\t +\def\samp#1{`\tclose{#1}'\null} +\setfont\keyrm\rmshape{8}{1000} +\font\keysy=cmsy9 +\def\key#1{{\keyrm\textfont2=\keysy \leavevmode\hbox{% + \raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleleft}\kern-.08em\vtop{% + \vbox{\hrule\kern-0.4pt + \hbox{\raise0.4pt\hbox{\vphantom{\angleleft}}#1}}% + \kern-0.4pt\hrule}% + \kern-.06em\raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleright}}}} +% The old definition, with no lozenge: +%\def\key #1{{\ttsl \nohyphenation \uppercase{#1}}\null} \def\ctrl #1{{\tt \rawbackslash \hat}#1} +% @file, @option are the same as @samp. \let\file=\samp +\let\option=\samp % @code is a modification of @t, % which makes spaces the same size as normal in the surrounding text. @@ -1139,55 +1601,167 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.} } % We *must* turn on hyphenation at `-' and `_' in \code. -% Otherwise, it is too hard to avoid overful hboxes +% Otherwise, it is too hard to avoid overfull hboxes % in the Emacs manual, the Library manual, etc. % Unfortunately, TeX uses one parameter (\hyphenchar) to control % both hyphenation at - and hyphenation within words. % We must therefore turn them both off (\tclose does that) -% and arrange explicitly to hyphenate an a dash. +% and arrange explicitly to hyphenate at a dash. % -- rms. { -\catcode`\-=\active -\catcode`\_=\active -\global\def\code{\begingroup \catcode`\-=\active \let-\codedash \catcode`\_=\active \let_\codeunder \codex} -% The following is used by \doprintindex to insure that long function names -% wrap around. It is necessary for - and _ to be active before the index is -% read from the file, as \entry parses the arguments long before \code is -% ever called. -- mycroft -\global\def\indexbreaks{\catcode`\-=\active \let-\realdash \catcode`\_=\active \let_\realunder} + \catcode`\-=\active + \catcode`\_=\active + % + \global\def\code{\begingroup + \catcode`\-=\active \let-\codedash + \catcode`\_=\active \let_\codeunder + \codex + } + % + % If we end up with any active - characters when handling the index, + % just treat them as a normal -. + \global\def\indexbreaks{\catcode`\-=\active \let-\realdash} } + \def\realdash{-} -\def\realunder{_} \def\codedash{-\discretionary{}{}{}} -\def\codeunder{\normalunderscore\discretionary{}{}{}} +\def\codeunder{% + % this is all so @math{@code{var_name}+1} can work. In math mode, _ + % is "active" (mathcode"8000) and \normalunderscore (or \char95, etc.) + % will therefore expand the active definition of _, which is us + % (inside @code that is), therefore an endless loop. + \ifusingtt{\ifmmode + \mathchar"075F % class 0=ordinary, family 7=ttfam, pos 0x5F=_. + \else\normalunderscore \fi + \discretionary{}{}{}}% + {\_}% +} \def\codex #1{\tclose{#1}\endgroup} -%\let\exp=\tclose %Was temporary - % @kbd is like @code, except that if the argument is just one @key command, % then @kbd has no effect. +% @kbdinputstyle -- arg is `distinct' (@kbd uses slanted tty font always), +% `example' (@kbd uses ttsl only inside of @example and friends), +% or `code' (@kbd uses normal tty font always). +\def\kbdinputstyle{\parsearg\kbdinputstylexxx} +\def\kbdinputstylexxx#1{% + \def\arg{#1}% + \ifx\arg\worddistinct + \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\ttsl}% + \else\ifx\arg\wordexample + \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}% + \else\ifx\arg\wordcode + \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\tt}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}% + \else + \errhelp = \EMsimple + \errmessage{Unknown @kbdinputstyle option `\arg'}% + \fi\fi\fi +} +\def\worddistinct{distinct} +\def\wordexample{example} +\def\wordcode{code} + +% Default is `distinct.' +\kbdinputstyle distinct + \def\xkey{\key} \def\kbdfoo#1#2#3\par{\def\one{#1}\def\three{#3}\def\threex{??}% \ifx\one\xkey\ifx\threex\three \key{#2}% -\else\tclose{\look}\fi -\else\tclose{\look}\fi} +\else{\tclose{\kbdfont\look}}\fi +\else{\tclose{\kbdfont\look}}\fi} + +% For @url, @env, @command quotes seem unnecessary, so use \code. +\let\url=\code +\let\env=\code +\let\command=\code + +% @uref (abbreviation for `urlref') takes an optional (comma-separated) +% second argument specifying the text to display and an optional third +% arg as text to display instead of (rather than in addition to) the url +% itself. First (mandatory) arg is the url. Perhaps eventually put in +% a hypertex \special here. +% +\def\uref#1{\douref #1,,,\finish} +\def\douref#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{\begingroup + \unsepspaces + \pdfurl{#1}% + \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}% + \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt + \unhbox0 % third arg given, show only that + \else + \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% + \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt + \ifpdf + \unhbox0 % PDF: 2nd arg given, show only it + \else + \unhbox0\ (\code{#1})% DVI: 2nd arg given, show both it and url + \fi + \else + \code{#1}% only url given, so show it + \fi + \fi + \endlink +\endgroup} + +% rms does not like angle brackets --karl, 17may97. +% So now @email is just like @uref, unless we are pdf. +% +%\def\email#1{\angleleft{\tt #1}\angleright} +\ifpdf + \def\email#1{\doemail#1,,\finish} + \def\doemail#1,#2,#3\finish{\begingroup + \unsepspaces + \pdfurl{mailto:#1}% + \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% + \ifdim\wd0>0pt\unhbox0\else\code{#1}\fi + \endlink + \endgroup} +\else + \let\email=\uref +\fi + +% Check if we are currently using a typewriter font. Since all the +% Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero interword stretch (and +% shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all typewriter fonts to have +% this property, we can check that font parameter. +% +\def\ifmonospace{\ifdim\fontdimen3\font=0pt } % Typeset a dimension, e.g., `in' or `pt'. The only reason for the -% argument is to make the input look right: @dmn{pt} instead of -% @dmn{}pt. +% argument is to make the input look right: @dmn{pt} instead of @dmn{}pt. % \def\dmn#1{\thinspace #1} \def\kbd#1{\def\look{#1}\expandafter\kbdfoo\look??\par} -\def\l#1{{\li #1}\null} % +% @l was never documented to mean ``switch to the Lisp font'', +% and it is not used as such in any manual I can find. We need it for +% Polish suppressed-l. --karl, 22sep96. +%\def\l#1{{\li #1}\null} + +% Explicit font changes: @r, @sc, undocumented @ii. +\def\r#1{{\rm #1}} % roman font +\def\sc#1{{\smallcaps#1}} % smallcaps font +\def\ii#1{{\it #1}} % italic font + +% @acronym downcases the argument and prints in smallcaps. +\def\acronym#1{{\smallcaps \lowercase{#1}}} + +% @pounds{} is a sterling sign. +\def\pounds{{\it\$}} + +% @registeredsymbol - R in a circle. For now, only works in text size; +% we'd have to redo the font mechanism to change the \scriptstyle and +% \scriptscriptstyle font sizes to make it look right in headings. +% Adapted from the plain.tex definition of \copyright. +% +\def\registeredsymbol{% + $^{{\ooalign{\hfil\raise.07ex\hbox{$\scriptstyle\rm R$}\hfil\crcr\Orb}}% + }$% +} -\def\r#1{{\rm #1}} % roman font -% Use of \lowercase was suggested. -\def\sc#1{{\smallcaps#1}} % smallcaps font -\def\ii#1{{\it #1}} % italic font \message{page headings,} @@ -1195,33 +1769,37 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.} \newskip\titlepagebottomglue \titlepagebottomglue = 2pc % First the title page. Must do @settitle before @titlepage. -\def\titlefont#1{{\titlerm #1}} - \newif\ifseenauthor \newif\iffinishedtitlepage +% Do an implicit @contents or @shortcontents after @end titlepage if the +% user says @setcontentsaftertitlepage or @setshortcontentsaftertitlepage. +% +\newif\ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage + \let\setcontentsaftertitlepage = \setcontentsaftertitlepagetrue +\newif\ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage + \let\setshortcontentsaftertitlepage = \setshortcontentsaftertitlepagetrue + \def\shorttitlepage{\parsearg\shorttitlepagezzz} \def\shorttitlepagezzz #1{\begingroup\hbox{}\vskip 1.5in \chaprm \centerline{#1}% - \endgroup\page\hbox{}\page} + \endgroup\page\hbox{}\page} \def\titlepage{\begingroup \parindent=0pt \textfonts \let\subtitlerm=\tenrm -% I deinstalled the following change because \cmr12 is undefined. -% This change was not in the ChangeLog anyway. --rms. -% \let\subtitlerm=\cmr12 \def\subtitlefont{\subtitlerm \normalbaselineskip = 13pt \normalbaselines}% % - \def\authorfont{\authorrm \normalbaselineskip = 16pt \normalbaselines}% + \def\authorfont{\authorrm \normalbaselineskip = 16pt \normalbaselines + \let\tt=\authortt}% % % Leave some space at the very top of the page. \vglue\titlepagetopglue % % Now you can print the title using @title. \def\title{\parsearg\titlezzz}% - \def\titlezzz##1{\leftline{\titlefont{##1}} - % print a rule at the page bottom also. - \finishedtitlepagefalse - \vskip4pt \hrule height 4pt width \hsize \vskip4pt}% + \def\titlezzz##1{\leftline{\titlefonts\rm ##1} + % print a rule at the page bottom also. + \finishedtitlepagefalse + \vskip4pt \hrule height 4pt width \hsize \vskip4pt}% % No rule at page bottom unless we print one at the top with @title. \finishedtitlepagetrue % @@ -1239,7 +1817,7 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.} \let\oldpage = \page \def\page{% \iffinishedtitlepage\else - \finishtitlepage + \finishtitlepage \fi \oldpage \let\page = \oldpage @@ -1257,7 +1835,24 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.} % after the title page, which we certainly don't want. \oldpage \endgroup + % + % Need this before the \...aftertitlepage checks so that if they are + % in effect the toc pages will come out with page numbers. \HEADINGSon + % + % If they want short, they certainly want long too. + \ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage + \shortcontents + \contents + \global\let\shortcontents = \relax + \global\let\contents = \relax + \fi + % + \ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage + \contents + \global\let\contents = \relax + \global\let\shortcontents = \relax + \fi } \def\finishtitlepage{% @@ -1270,10 +1865,10 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.} \let\thispage=\folio -\newtoks \evenheadline % Token sequence for heading line of even pages -\newtoks \oddheadline % Token sequence for heading line of odd pages -\newtoks \evenfootline % Token sequence for footing line of even pages -\newtoks \oddfootline % Token sequence for footing line of odd pages +\newtoks\evenheadline % headline on even pages +\newtoks\oddheadline % headline on odd pages +\newtoks\evenfootline % footline on even pages +\newtoks\oddfootline % footline on odd pages % Now make Tex use those variables \headline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddheadline @@ -1307,10 +1902,7 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.} \gdef\oddheadingyyy #1@|#2@|#3@|#4\finish{% \global\oddheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}} -\gdef\everyheadingxxx #1{\everyheadingyyy #1@|@|@|@|\finish} -\gdef\everyheadingyyy #1@|#2@|#3@|#4\finish{% -\global\evenheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}} -\global\oddheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}} +\gdef\everyheadingxxx#1{\oddheadingxxx{#1}\evenheadingxxx{#1}}% \gdef\evenfootingxxx #1{\evenfootingyyy #1@|@|@|@|\finish} \gdef\evenfootingyyy #1@|#2@|#3@|#4\finish{% @@ -1318,23 +1910,27 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.} \gdef\oddfootingxxx #1{\oddfootingyyy #1@|@|@|@|\finish} \gdef\oddfootingyyy #1@|#2@|#3@|#4\finish{% -\global\oddfootline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}} + \global\oddfootline = {\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}% + % + % Leave some space for the footline. Hopefully ok to assume + % @evenfooting will not be used by itself. + \global\advance\pageheight by -\baselineskip + \global\advance\vsize by -\baselineskip +} -\gdef\everyfootingxxx #1{\everyfootingyyy #1@|@|@|@|\finish} -\gdef\everyfootingyyy #1@|#2@|#3@|#4\finish{% -\global\evenfootline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}} -\global\oddfootline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}} +\gdef\everyfootingxxx#1{\oddfootingxxx{#1}\evenfootingxxx{#1}} % }% unbind the catcode of @. -% @headings double turns headings on for double-sided printing. -% @headings single turns headings on for single-sided printing. -% @headings off turns them off. -% @headings on same as @headings double, retained for compatibility. -% @headings after turns on double-sided headings after this page. -% @headings doubleafter turns on double-sided headings after this page. +% @headings double turns headings on for double-sided printing. +% @headings single turns headings on for single-sided printing. +% @headings off turns them off. +% @headings on same as @headings double, retained for compatibility. +% @headings after turns on double-sided headings after this page. +% @headings doubleafter turns on double-sided headings after this page. % @headings singleafter turns on single-sided headings after this page. -% By default, they are off. +% By default, they are off at the start of a document, +% and turned `on' after @end titlepage. \def\headings #1 {\csname HEADINGS#1\endcsname} @@ -1348,22 +1944,24 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.} % title on inside top of left hand pages, and page numbers on outside top % edge of all pages. \def\HEADINGSdouble{ -%\pagealignmacro \global\pageno=1 \global\evenfootline={\hfil} \global\oddfootline={\hfil} \global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}} \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} +\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage } +\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager + % For single-sided printing, chapter title goes across top left of page, % page number on top right. \def\HEADINGSsingle{ -%\pagealignmacro \global\pageno=1 \global\evenfootline={\hfil} \global\oddfootline={\hfil} \global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} +\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager } \def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble} @@ -1374,6 +1972,7 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.} \global\oddfootline={\hfil} \global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}} \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} +\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage } \def\HEADINGSsingleafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSsinglex} @@ -1382,42 +1981,32 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.} \global\oddfootline={\hfil} \global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} +\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager } % Subroutines used in generating headings -% Produces Day Month Year style of output. -\def\today{\number\day\space -\ifcase\month\or -January\or February\or March\or April\or May\or June\or -July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi -\space\number\year} - -% Use this if you want the Month Day, Year style of output. -%\def\today{\ifcase\month\or -%January\or February\or March\or April\or May\or June\or -%July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi -%\space\number\day, \number\year} - -% @settitle line... specifies the title of the document, for headings -% It generates no output of its own - -\def\thistitle{No Title} +% This produces Day Month Year style of output. +% Only define if not already defined, in case a txi-??.tex file has set +% up a different format (e.g., txi-cs.tex does this). +\ifx\today\undefined +\def\today{% + \number\day\space + \ifcase\month + \or\putwordMJan\or\putwordMFeb\or\putwordMMar\or\putwordMApr + \or\putwordMMay\or\putwordMJun\or\putwordMJul\or\putwordMAug + \or\putwordMSep\or\putwordMOct\or\putwordMNov\or\putwordMDec + \fi + \space\number\year} +\fi + +% @settitle line... specifies the title of the document, for headings. +% It generates no output of its own. +\def\thistitle{\putwordNoTitle} \def\settitle{\parsearg\settitlezzz} \def\settitlezzz #1{\gdef\thistitle{#1}} -\message{tables,} - -% @tabs -- simple alignment - -% These don't work. For one thing, \+ is defined as outer. -% So these macros cannot even be defined. - -%\def\tabs{\parsearg\tabszzz} -%\def\tabszzz #1{\settabs\+#1\cr} -%\def\tabline{\parsearg\tablinezzz} -%\def\tablinezzz #1{\+#1\cr} -%\def\&{&} +\message{tables,} % Tables -- @table, @ftable, @vtable, @item(x), @kitem(x), @xitem(x). % default indentation of table text @@ -1437,7 +2026,7 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi \newif\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip -\def\itemxpar{\par\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip\vskip-\parskip\nobreak\fi} +\def\itemxpar{\par\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip\nobreak\vskip-\parskip\nobreak\fi} \def\internalBitem{\smallbreak \parsearg\itemzzz} \def\internalBitemx{\itemxpar \parsearg\itemzzz} @@ -1461,11 +2050,6 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi \itemindex{#1}% \nobreak % This prevents a break before @itemx. % - % Be sure we are not still in the middle of a paragraph. - %{\parskip = 0in - %\par - %}% - % % If the item text does not fit in the space we have, put it on a line % by itself, and do not allow a page break either before or after that % line. We do not start a paragraph here because then if the next @@ -1486,21 +2070,33 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi % \parskip glue -- logically it's part of the @item we just started. \nobreak \vskip-\parskip % - % Stop a page break at the \parskip glue coming up. Unfortunately + % Stop a page break at the \parskip glue coming up. (Unfortunately % we can't prevent a possible page break at the following - % \baselineskip glue. - \nobreak + % \baselineskip glue.) However, if what follows is an environment + % such as @example, there will be no \parskip glue; then + % the negative vskip we just would cause the example and the item to + % crash together. So we use this bizarre value of 10001 as a signal + % to \aboveenvbreak to insert \parskip glue after all. + % (Possibly there are other commands that could be followed by + % @example which need the same treatment, but not section titles; or + % maybe section titles are the only special case and they should be + % penalty 10001...) + \penalty 10001 \endgroup \itemxneedsnegativevskipfalse \else % The item text fits into the space. Start a paragraph, so that the - % following text (if any) will end up on the same line. Since that - % text will be indented by \tableindent, we make the item text be in - % a zero-width box. + % following text (if any) will end up on the same line. \noindent - \rlap{\hskip -\tableindent\box0}\ignorespaces% - \endgroup% - \itemxneedsnegativevskiptrue% + % Do this with kerns and \unhbox so that if there is a footnote in + % the item text, it can migrate to the main vertical list and + % eventually be printed. + \nobreak\kern-\tableindent + \dimen0 = \itemmax \advance\dimen0 by \itemmargin \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0 + \unhbox0 + \nobreak\kern\dimen0 + \endgroup + \itemxneedsnegativevskiptrue \fi } @@ -1511,9 +2107,10 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi \def\xitem{\errmessage{@xitem while not in a table}} \def\xitemx{\errmessage{@xitemx while not in a table}} -%% Contains a kludge to get @end[description] to work +% Contains a kludge to get @end[description] to work. \def\description{\tablez{\dontindex}{1}{}{}{}{}} +% @table, @ftable, @vtable. \def\table{\begingroup\inENV\obeylines\obeyspaces\tablex} {\obeylines\obeyspaces% \gdef\tablex #1^^M{% @@ -1544,7 +2141,7 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi \def\tablez #1#2#3#4#5#6{% \aboveenvbreak % \begingroup % -\def\Edescription{\Etable}% Neccessary kludge. +\def\Edescription{\Etable}% Necessary kludge. \let\itemindex=#1% \ifnum 0#3>0 \advance \leftskip by #3\mil \fi % \ifnum 0#4>0 \tableindent=#4\mil \fi % @@ -1573,27 +2170,25 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi \def\itemize{\parsearg\itemizezzz} \def\itemizezzz #1{% - \begingroup % ended by the @end itemsize + \begingroup % ended by the @end itemize \itemizey {#1}{\Eitemize} } -\def\itemizey #1#2{% -\aboveenvbreak % -\itemmax=\itemindent % -\advance \itemmax by -\itemmargin % -\advance \leftskip by \itemindent % -\exdentamount=\itemindent -\parindent = 0pt % -\parskip = \smallskipamount % -\ifdim \parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi% -\def#2{\endgraf\afterenvbreak\endgroup}% -\def\itemcontents{#1}% -\let\item=\itemizeitem} - -% Set sfcode to normal for the chars that usually have another value. -% These are `.?!:;,' -\def\frenchspacing{\sfcode46=1000 \sfcode63=1000 \sfcode33=1000 - \sfcode58=1000 \sfcode59=1000 \sfcode44=1000 } +\def\itemizey#1#2{% + \aboveenvbreak + \itemmax=\itemindent + \advance\itemmax by -\itemmargin + \advance\leftskip by \itemindent + \exdentamount=\itemindent + \parindent=0pt + \parskip=\smallskipamount + \ifdim\parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi + \def#2{\endgraf\afterenvbreak\endgroup}% + \def\itemcontents{#1}% + % @itemize with no arg is equivalent to @itemize @bullet. + \ifx\itemcontents\empty\def\itemcontents{\bullet}\fi + \let\item=\itemizeitem +} % \splitoff TOKENS\endmark defines \first to be the first token in % TOKENS, and \rest to be the remainder. @@ -1701,17 +2296,17 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi \def\itemizeitem{% \advance\itemno by 1 {\let\par=\endgraf \smallbreak}% -\ifhmode \errmessage{\in hmode at itemizeitem}\fi +\ifhmode \errmessage{In hmode at itemizeitem}\fi {\parskip=0in \hskip 0pt \hbox to 0pt{\hss \itemcontents\hskip \itemmargin}% \vadjust{\penalty 1200}}% \flushcr} % @multitable macros -% Amy Hendrickson, 8/18/94 +% Amy Hendrickson, 8/18/94, 3/6/96 % -% @multitable ... @endmultitable will make as many columns as desired. -% Contents of each column will wrap at width given in preamble. Width +% @multitable ... @end multitable will make as many columns as desired. +% Contents of each column will wrap at width given in preamble. Width % can be specified either with sample text given in a template line, % or in percent of \hsize, the current width of text on page. @@ -1719,388 +2314,952 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi % To make preamble: % -% Either define widths of columns in terms of percent of \hsize: -% @multitable @percentofhsize .2 .3 .5 +% Either define widths of columns in terms of percent of \hsize: +% @multitable @columnfractions .25 .3 .45 % @item ... % -% Numbers following @percentofhsize are the percent of the total +% Numbers following @columnfractions are the percent of the total % current hsize to be used for each column. You may use as many % columns as desired. + % Or use a template: % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template} % @item ... % using the widest term desired in each column. +% +% For those who want to use more than one line's worth of words in +% the preamble, break the line within one argument and it +% will parse correctly, i.e., +% +% @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 +% template} +% Not: +% @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} +% {Column 3 template} - -% Each new table line starts with @item, each subsequent new column +% Each new table line starts with @item, each subsequent new column % starts with @tab. Empty columns may be produced by supplying @tab's % with nothing between them for as many times as empty columns are needed, % ie, @tab@tab@tab will produce two empty columns. -% @item, @tab, @multicolumn or @endmulticolumn do not need to be on their +% @item, @tab, @multitable or @end multitable do not need to be on their % own lines, but it will not hurt if they are. % Sample multitable: % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template} % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff @tab third col -% @item -% first col stuff -% @tab -% second col stuff -% @tab -% third col -% @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff +% @item +% first col stuff +% @tab +% second col stuff +% @tab +% third col +% @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff % @tab Many paragraphs of text may be used in any column. -% +% % They will wrap at the width determined by the template. % @item@tab@tab This will be in third column. -% @endmultitable +% @end multitable % Default dimensions may be reset by user. -% @intableparskip will set vertical space between paragraphs in table. -% @intableparindent will set paragraph indent in table. -% @spacebetweencols will set horizontal space to be left between columns. -% @spacebetweenlines will set vertical space to be left between lines. - -%%%% -% Dimensions - -\newdimen\intableparskip -\newdimen\intableparindent -\newdimen\spacebetweencols -\newdimen\spacebetweenlines -\intableparskip=0pt -\intableparindent=6pt -\spacebetweencols=12pt -\spacebetweenlines=12pt - -%%%% +% @multitableparskip is vertical space between paragraphs in table. +% @multitableparindent is paragraph indent in table. +% @multitablecolmargin is horizontal space to be left between columns. +% @multitablelinespace is space to leave between table items, baseline +% to baseline. +% 0pt means it depends on current normal line spacing. +% +\newskip\multitableparskip +\newskip\multitableparindent +\newdimen\multitablecolspace +\newskip\multitablelinespace +\multitableparskip=0pt +\multitableparindent=6pt +\multitablecolspace=12pt +\multitablelinespace=0pt + % Macros used to set up halign preamble: +% \let\endsetuptable\relax \def\xendsetuptable{\endsetuptable} -\let\percentofhsize\relax -\def\xpercentofhsize{\percentofhsize} +\let\columnfractions\relax +\def\xcolumnfractions{\columnfractions} \newif\ifsetpercent +% #1 is the part of the @columnfraction before the decimal point, which +% is presumably either 0 or the empty string (but we don't check, we +% just throw it away). #2 is the decimal part, which we use as the +% percent of \hsize for this column. +\def\pickupwholefraction#1.#2 {% + \global\advance\colcount by 1 + \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{.#2\hsize}% + \setuptable +} + \newcount\colcount -\def\setuptable#1{\def\firstarg{#1}% -\ifx\firstarg\xendsetuptable\let\go\relax% -\else - \ifx\firstarg\xpercentofhsize\global\setpercenttrue% +\def\setuptable#1{% + \def\firstarg{#1}% + \ifx\firstarg\xendsetuptable + \let\go = \relax \else - \ifsetpercent - \if#1.\else% - \global\advance\colcount by1 % - \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{.#1\hsize}% - \fi + \ifx\firstarg\xcolumnfractions + \global\setpercenttrue + \else + \ifsetpercent + \let\go\pickupwholefraction + \else + \global\advance\colcount by 1 + \setbox0=\hbox{#1\unskip\space}% Add a normal word space as a + % separator; typically that is always in the input, anyway. + \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{\the\wd0}% + \fi + \fi + \ifx\go\pickupwholefraction + % Put the argument back for the \pickupwholefraction call, so + % we'll always have a period there to be parsed. + \def\go{\pickupwholefraction#1}% \else - \global\advance\colcount by1 - \setbox0=\hbox{#1}% - \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{\the\wd0}% + \let\go = \setuptable \fi% - \fi% - \let\go\setuptable% -\fi\go} -%%%% -% multitable syntax -\def\tab{&} - -%%%% -% @multitable ... @endmultitable definitions: - -\def\multitable#1\item{\bgroup -\let\item\cr -\tolerance=9500 -\hbadness=9500 -\parskip=\intableparskip -\parindent=\intableparindent -\overfullrule=0pt -\global\colcount=0\relax% -\def\Emultitable{\global\setpercentfalse\global\everycr{}\cr\egroup\egroup}% - % To parse everything between @multitable and @item : -\def\one{#1}\expandafter\setuptable\one\endsetuptable - % Need to reset this to 0 after \setuptable. -\global\colcount=0\relax% - % - % This preamble sets up a generic column definition, which will - % be used as many times as user calls for columns. - % \vtop will set a single line and will also let text wrap and - % continue for many paragraphs if desired. -\halign\bgroup&\global\advance\colcount by 1\relax% -\vtop{\hsize=\expandafter\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname - % In order to keep entries from bumping into each other - % we will add a \leftskip of \spacebetweencols to all columns after - % the first one. - % If a template has been used, we will add \spacebetweencols - % to the width of each template entry. - % If user has set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize - % we will use that dimension as the width of the column, and - % the \leftskip will keep entries from bumping into each other. - % Table will start at left margin and final column will justify at - % right margin. -\ifnum\colcount=1 -\else - \ifsetpercent - \else - % If user has set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize - % we will advance \hsize by \spacebetweencols - \advance\hsize by \spacebetweencols \fi - % In either case we will make \leftskip=\spacebetweencols: -\leftskip=\spacebetweencols -\fi -\noindent##}\cr% - % \everycr will reset column counter, \colcount, at the end of - % each line. Every column entry will cause \colcount to advance by one. - % The table preamble - % looks at the current \colcount to find the correct column width. -\global\everycr{\noalign{\nointerlineskip\vskip\spacebetweenlines -\filbreak%% keeps underfull box messages off when table breaks over pages. -\global\colcount=0\relax}}} - -\message{indexing,} -% Index generation facilities + \go +} -% Define \newwrite to be identical to plain tex's \newwrite -% except not \outer, so it can be used within \newindex. -{\catcode`\@=11 -\gdef\newwrite{\alloc@7\write\chardef\sixt@@n}} +% @multitable ... @end multitable definitions: +% +\def\multitable{\parsearg\dotable} +\def\dotable#1{\bgroup + \vskip\parskip + \let\item=\crcrwithfootnotes + % A \tab used to include \hskip1sp. But then the space in a template + % line is not enough. That is bad. So let's go back to just & until + % we encounter the problem it was intended to solve again. --karl, + % nathan@acm.org, 20apr99. + \let\tab=&% + \let\startfootins=\startsavedfootnote + \tolerance=9500 + \hbadness=9500 + \setmultitablespacing + \parskip=\multitableparskip + \parindent=\multitableparindent + \overfullrule=0pt + \global\colcount=0 + \def\Emultitable{% + \global\setpercentfalse + \crcrwithfootnotes\crcr + \egroup\egroup + }% + % + % To parse everything between @multitable and @item: + \setuptable#1 \endsetuptable + % + % \everycr will reset column counter, \colcount, at the end of + % each line. Every column entry will cause \colcount to advance by one. + % The table preamble + % looks at the current \colcount to find the correct column width. + \everycr{\noalign{% + % + % \filbreak%% keeps underfull box messages off when table breaks over pages. + % Maybe so, but it also creates really weird page breaks when the table + % breaks over pages. Wouldn't \vfil be better? Wait until the problem + % manifests itself, so it can be fixed for real --karl. + \global\colcount=0\relax}}% + % + % This preamble sets up a generic column definition, which will + % be used as many times as user calls for columns. + % \vtop will set a single line and will also let text wrap and + % continue for many paragraphs if desired. + \halign\bgroup&\global\advance\colcount by 1\relax + \multistrut\vtop{\hsize=\expandafter\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname + % + % In order to keep entries from bumping into each other + % we will add a \leftskip of \multitablecolspace to all columns after + % the first one. + % + % If a template has been used, we will add \multitablecolspace + % to the width of each template entry. + % + % If the user has set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize we will + % use that dimension as the width of the column, and the \leftskip + % will keep entries from bumping into each other. Table will start at + % left margin and final column will justify at right margin. + % + % Make sure we don't inherit \rightskip from the outer environment. + \rightskip=0pt + \ifnum\colcount=1 + % The first column will be indented with the surrounding text. + \advance\hsize by\leftskip + \else + \ifsetpercent \else + % If user has not set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize + % we will advance \hsize by \multitablecolspace. + \advance\hsize by \multitablecolspace + \fi + % In either case we will make \leftskip=\multitablecolspace: + \leftskip=\multitablecolspace + \fi + % Ignoring space at the beginning and end avoids an occasional spurious + % blank line, when TeX decides to break the line at the space before the + % box from the multistrut, so the strut ends up on a line by itself. + % For example: + % @multitable @columnfractions .11 .89 + % @item @code{#} + % @tab Legal holiday which is valid in major parts of the whole country. + % Is automatically provided with highlighting sequences respectively marking + % characters. + \noindent\ignorespaces##\unskip\multistrut}\cr +} -% \newindex {foo} defines an index named foo. -% It automatically defines \fooindex such that -% \fooindex ...rest of line... puts an entry in the index foo. -% It also defines \fooindfile to be the number of the output channel for -% the file that accumulates this index. The file's extension is foo. -% The name of an index should be no more than 2 characters long -% for the sake of vms. +\def\setmultitablespacing{% test to see if user has set \multitablelinespace. +% If so, do nothing. If not, give it an appropriate dimension based on +% current baselineskip. +\ifdim\multitablelinespace=0pt +\setbox0=\vbox{X}\global\multitablelinespace=\the\baselineskip +\global\advance\multitablelinespace by-\ht0 +%% strut to put in table in case some entry doesn't have descenders, +%% to keep lines equally spaced +\let\multistrut = \strut +\else +%% FIXME: what is \box0 supposed to be? +\gdef\multistrut{\vrule height\multitablelinespace depth\dp0 +width0pt\relax} \fi +%% Test to see if parskip is larger than space between lines of +%% table. If not, do nothing. +%% If so, set to same dimension as multitablelinespace. +\ifdim\multitableparskip>\multitablelinespace +\global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace +\global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt %% to keep parskip somewhat smaller + %% than skip between lines in the table. +\fi% +\ifdim\multitableparskip=0pt +\global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace +\global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt %% to keep parskip somewhat smaller + %% than skip between lines in the table. +\fi} + +% In case a @footnote appears inside an alignment, save the footnote +% text to a box and make the \insert when a row of the table is +% finished. Otherwise, the insertion is lost, it never migrates to the +% main vertical list. --kasal, 22jan03. +% +\newbox\savedfootnotes +% +% \dotable \let's \startfootins to this, so that \dofootnote will call +% it instead of starting the insertion right away. +\def\startsavedfootnote{% + \global\setbox\savedfootnotes = \vbox\bgroup + \unvbox\savedfootnotes +} +\def\crcrwithfootnotes{% + \crcr + \ifvoid\savedfootnotes \else + \noalign{\insert\footins{\box\savedfootnotes}}% + \fi +} -\def\newindex #1{ -\expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname% Define number for output file -\openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1 % Open the file -\expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% % Define \xxxindex -\noexpand\doindex {#1}} +\message{conditionals,} +% Prevent errors for section commands. +% Used in @ignore and in failing conditionals. +\def\ignoresections{% + \let\appendix=\relax + \let\appendixsec=\relax + \let\appendixsection=\relax + \let\appendixsubsec=\relax + \let\appendixsubsection=\relax + \let\appendixsubsubsec=\relax + \let\appendixsubsubsection=\relax + %\let\begin=\relax + %\let\bye=\relax + \let\centerchap=\relax + \let\chapter=\relax + \let\contents=\relax + \let\section=\relax + \let\smallbook=\relax + \let\subsec=\relax + \let\subsection=\relax + \let\subsubsec=\relax + \let\subsubsection=\relax + \let\titlepage=\relax + \let\top=\relax + \let\unnumbered=\relax + \let\unnumberedsec=\relax + \let\unnumberedsection=\relax + \let\unnumberedsubsec=\relax + \let\unnumberedsubsection=\relax + \let\unnumberedsubsubsec=\relax + \let\unnumberedsubsubsection=\relax } -% @defindex foo == \newindex{foo} +% Ignore @ignore, @ifhtml, @ifinfo, and the like. +% +\def\direntry{\doignore{direntry}} +\def\documentdescriptionword{documentdescription} +\def\documentdescription{\doignore{documentdescription}} +\def\html{\doignore{html}} +\def\ifhtml{\doignore{ifhtml}} +\def\ifinfo{\doignore{ifinfo}} +\def\ifnottex{\doignore{ifnottex}} +\def\ifplaintext{\doignore{ifplaintext}} +\def\ifxml{\doignore{ifxml}} +\def\ignore{\doignore{ignore}} +\def\menu{\doignore{menu}} +\def\xml{\doignore{xml}} -\def\defindex{\parsearg\newindex} +% @dircategory CATEGORY -- specify a category of the dir file +% which this file should belong to. Ignore this in TeX. +\let\dircategory = \comment -% Define @defcodeindex, like @defindex except put all entries in @code. +% Ignore text until a line `@end #1', keeping track of nested conditionals. +% +% A count to remember the depth of nesting. +\newcount\doignorecount -\def\newcodeindex #1{ -\expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname% Define number for output file -\openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1 % Open the file -\expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% % Define \xxxindex -\noexpand\docodeindex {#1}} +\def\doignore#1{\begingroup + % Don't complain about control sequences we have declared \outer. + \ignoresections + % + % Make sure that spaces turn into tokens that match what \doignoretext wants. + \catcode\spaceChar = 10 + % + % Ignore braces, so mismatched braces don't cause trouble. + \catcode`\{ = 9 + \catcode`\} = 9 + % + % Count number of #1's that we've seen. + \doignorecount = 0 + % + % Swallow text until we reach the matching `@end #1'. + \expandafter \dodoignore \csname#1\endcsname {#1}% } -\def\defcodeindex{\parsearg\newcodeindex} - -% @synindex foo bar makes index foo feed into index bar. -% Do this instead of @defindex foo if you don't want it as a separate index. -\def\synindex #1 #2 {% -\expandafter\let\expandafter\synindexfoo\expandafter=\csname#2indfile\endcsname -\expandafter\let\csname#1indfile\endcsname=\synindexfoo -\expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% % Define \xxxindex -\noexpand\doindex {#2}}% +{ \catcode`@=11 % We want to use \ST@P which cannot appear in texinfo source. + \obeylines % + % + \gdef\dodoignore#1#2{% + % #1 contains, e.g., \ifinfo, a.k.a. @ifinfo. + % #2 contains the string `ifinfo'. + % + % Define a command to find the next `@end #2', which must be on a line + % by itself. + \long\def\doignoretext##1^^M\end #2{\doignoretextyyy##1^^M#1\ST@P}% + % And this command to find another #1 command, at the beginning of a + % line. (Otherwise, we would consider a line `@c @ifset', for + % example, to count as an @ifset for nesting.) + \long\def\doignoretextyyy##1^^M#1##2\ST@P{\doignoreyyy{##2}\ST@P}% + % + % And now expand that command. + \obeylines % + \doignoretext ^^M% + }% } -% @syncodeindex foo bar similar, but put all entries made for index foo -% inside @code. -\def\syncodeindex #1 #2 {% -\expandafter\let\expandafter\synindexfoo\expandafter=\csname#2indfile\endcsname -\expandafter\let\csname#1indfile\endcsname=\synindexfoo -\expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% % Define \xxxindex -\noexpand\docodeindex {#2}}% +\def\doignoreyyy#1{% + \def\temp{#1}% + \ifx\temp\empty % Nothing found. + \let\next\doignoretextzzz + \else % Found a nested condition, ... + \advance\doignorecount by 1 + \let\next\doignoretextyyy % ..., look for another. + % If we're here, #1 ends with ^^M\ifinfo (for example). + \fi + \next #1% the token \ST@P is present just after this macro. } -% Define \doindex, the driver for all \fooindex macros. -% Argument #1 is generated by the calling \fooindex macro, -% and it is "foo", the name of the index. - -% \doindex just uses \parsearg; it calls \doind for the actual work. -% This is because \doind is more useful to call from other macros. +% We have to swallow the remaining "\ST@P". +% +\def\doignoretextzzz#1{% + \ifnum\doignorecount = 0 % We have just found the outermost @end. + \let\next\enddoignore + \else % Still inside a nested condition. + \advance\doignorecount by -1 + \let\next\doignoretext % Look for the next @end. + \fi + \next +} -% There is also \dosubind {index}{topic}{subtopic} -% which makes an entry in a two-level index such as the operation index. +% Finish off ignored text. +\def\enddoignore{\endgroup\ignorespaces} -\def\doindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singleindexer} -\def\singleindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{#1}} -% like the previous two, but they put @code around the argument. -\def\docodeindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singlecodeindexer} -\def\singlecodeindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{\code{#1}}} +% @set VAR sets the variable VAR to an empty value. +% @set VAR REST-OF-LINE sets VAR to the value REST-OF-LINE. +% +% Since we want to separate VAR from REST-OF-LINE (which might be +% empty), we can't just use \parsearg; we have to insert a space of our +% own to delimit the rest of the line, and then take it out again if we +% didn't need it. Make sure the catcode of space is correct to avoid +% losing inside @example, for instance. +% +\def\set{\begingroup\catcode` =10 + \catcode`\-=12 \catcode`\_=12 % Allow - and _ in VAR. + \parsearg\setxxx} +\def\setxxx#1{\setyyy#1 \endsetyyy} +\def\setyyy#1 #2\endsetyyy{% + \def\temp{#2}% + \ifx\temp\empty \global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname = \empty + \else \setzzz{#1}#2\endsetzzz % Remove the trailing space \setxxx inserted. + \fi + \endgroup +} +% Can't use \xdef to pre-expand #2 and save some time, since \temp or +% \next or other control sequences that we've defined might get us into +% an infinite loop. Consider `@set foo @cite{bar}'. +\def\setzzz#1#2 \endsetzzz{\expandafter\gdef\csname SET#1\endcsname{#2}} -\def\indexdummies{% -% Take care of the plain tex accent commands. -\def\"{\realbackslash "}% -\def\`{\realbackslash `}% -\def\'{\realbackslash '}% -\def\^{\realbackslash ^}% -\def\~{\realbackslash ~}% -\def\={\realbackslash =}% -\def\b{\realbackslash b}% -\def\c{\realbackslash c}% -\def\d{\realbackslash d}% -\def\u{\realbackslash u}% -\def\v{\realbackslash v}% -\def\H{\realbackslash H}% -% Take care of the plain tex special European modified letters. -\def\oe{\realbackslash oe}% -\def\ae{\realbackslash ae}% -\def\aa{\realbackslash aa}% -\def\OE{\realbackslash OE}% -\def\AE{\realbackslash AE}% -\def\AA{\realbackslash AA}% -\def\o{\realbackslash o}% -\def\O{\realbackslash O}% -\def\l{\realbackslash l}% -\def\L{\realbackslash L}% -\def\ss{\realbackslash ss}% -% Take care of texinfo commands likely to appear in an index entry. -\def\_{{\realbackslash _}}% -\def\w{\realbackslash w }% -\def\bf{\realbackslash bf }% -\def\rm{\realbackslash rm }% -\def\sl{\realbackslash sl }% -\def\sf{\realbackslash sf}% -\def\tt{\realbackslash tt}% -\def\gtr{\realbackslash gtr}% -\def\less{\realbackslash less}% -\def\hat{\realbackslash hat}% -\def\char{\realbackslash char}% -\def\TeX{\realbackslash TeX}% -\def\dots{\realbackslash dots }% -\def\copyright{\realbackslash copyright }% -\def\tclose##1{\realbackslash tclose {##1}}% -\def\code##1{\realbackslash code {##1}}% -\def\samp##1{\realbackslash samp {##1}}% -\def\t##1{\realbackslash r {##1}}% -\def\r##1{\realbackslash r {##1}}% -\def\i##1{\realbackslash i {##1}}% -\def\b##1{\realbackslash b {##1}}% -\def\cite##1{\realbackslash cite {##1}}% -\def\key##1{\realbackslash key {##1}}% -\def\file##1{\realbackslash file {##1}}% -\def\var##1{\realbackslash var {##1}}% -\def\kbd##1{\realbackslash kbd {##1}}% -\def\dfn##1{\realbackslash dfn {##1}}% -\def\emph##1{\realbackslash emph {##1}}% -} - -% \indexnofonts no-ops all font-change commands. -% This is used when outputting the strings to sort the index by. -\def\indexdummyfont#1{#1} -\def\indexdummytex{TeX} -\def\indexdummydots{...} +% @clear VAR clears (i.e., unsets) the variable VAR. +% +\def\clear{\parsearg\clearxxx} +\def\clearxxx#1{\global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname=\relax} -\def\indexnofonts{% -% Just ignore accents. -\let\"=\indexdummyfont -\let\`=\indexdummyfont -\let\'=\indexdummyfont -\let\^=\indexdummyfont -\let\~=\indexdummyfont -\let\==\indexdummyfont -\let\b=\indexdummyfont -\let\c=\indexdummyfont -\let\d=\indexdummyfont -\let\u=\indexdummyfont -\let\v=\indexdummyfont -\let\H=\indexdummyfont -% Take care of the plain tex special European modified letters. -\def\oe{oe}% -\def\ae{ae}% -\def\aa{aa}% -\def\OE{OE}% -\def\AE{AE}% -\def\AA{AA}% -\def\o{o}% -\def\O{O}% -\def\l{l}% -\def\L{L}% -\def\ss{ss}% -\let\w=\indexdummyfont -\let\t=\indexdummyfont -\let\r=\indexdummyfont -\let\i=\indexdummyfont -\let\b=\indexdummyfont -\let\emph=\indexdummyfont -\let\strong=\indexdummyfont -\let\cite=\indexdummyfont -\let\sc=\indexdummyfont -%Don't no-op \tt, since it isn't a user-level command -% and is used in the definitions of the active chars like <, >, |... -%\let\tt=\indexdummyfont -\let\tclose=\indexdummyfont -\let\code=\indexdummyfont -\let\file=\indexdummyfont -\let\samp=\indexdummyfont -\let\kbd=\indexdummyfont -\let\key=\indexdummyfont -\let\var=\indexdummyfont -\let\TeX=\indexdummytex -\let\dots=\indexdummydots -} - -% To define \realbackslash, we must make \ not be an escape. -% We must first make another character (@) an escape -% so we do not become unable to do a definition. - -{\catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\other -@gdef@realbackslash{\}} +% @value{foo} gets the text saved in variable foo. +{ + \catcode`\_ = \active + % + % We might end up with active _ or - characters in the argument if + % we're called from @code, as @code{@value{foo-bar_}}. So \let any + % such active characters to their normal equivalents. + \gdef\value{\begingroup + \catcode`\-=\other \catcode`\_=\other + \indexbreaks \let_\normalunderscore + \valuexxx} +} +\def\valuexxx#1{\expandablevalue{#1}\endgroup} + +% We have this subroutine so that we can handle at least some @value's +% properly in indexes (we \let\value to this in \indexdummies). Ones +% whose names contain - or _ still won't work, but we can't do anything +% about that. The command has to be fully expandable (if the variable +% is set), since the result winds up in the index file. This means that +% if the variable's value contains other Texinfo commands, it's almost +% certain it will fail (although perhaps we could fix that with +% sufficient work to do a one-level expansion on the result, instead of +% complete). +% +\def\expandablevalue#1{% + \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax + {[No value for ``#1'']}% + \message{Variable `#1', used in @value, is not set.}% + \else + \csname SET#1\endcsname + \fi +} + +% @ifset VAR ... @end ifset reads the `...' iff VAR has been defined +% with @set. +% +\def\ifset{\parsearg\doifset} +\def\doifset#1{% + \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax + \let\next=\ifsetfail + \else + \let\next=\ifsetsucceed + \fi + \next +} +\def\ifsetsucceed{\conditionalsucceed{ifset}} +\def\ifsetfail{\doignore{ifset}} +\defineunmatchedend{ifset} + +% @ifclear VAR ... @end ifclear reads the `...' iff VAR has never been +% defined with @set, or has been undefined with @clear. +% +\def\ifclear{\parsearg\doifclear} +\def\doifclear#1{% + \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax + \let\next=\ifclearsucceed + \else + \let\next=\ifclearfail + \fi + \next +} +\def\ifclearsucceed{\conditionalsucceed{ifclear}} +\def\ifclearfail{\doignore{ifclear}} +\defineunmatchedend{ifclear} + +% @iftex, @ifnothtml, @ifnotinfo, @ifnotplaintext always succeed; we +% read the text following, through the first @end iftex (etc.). Make +% `@end iftex' (etc.) valid only after an @iftex. +% +\def\iftex{\conditionalsucceed{iftex}} +\def\ifnothtml{\conditionalsucceed{ifnothtml}} +\def\ifnotinfo{\conditionalsucceed{ifnotinfo}} +\def\ifnotplaintext{\conditionalsucceed{ifnotplaintext}} +\defineunmatchedend{iftex} +\defineunmatchedend{ifnothtml} +\defineunmatchedend{ifnotinfo} +\defineunmatchedend{ifnotplaintext} + +% True conditional. Since \set globally defines its variables, we can +% just start and end a group (to keep the @end definition undefined at +% the outer level). +% +\def\conditionalsucceed#1{\begingroup + \expandafter\def\csname E#1\endcsname{\endgroup}% +} + +% @defininfoenclose. +\let\definfoenclose=\comment + + +\message{indexing,} +% Index generation facilities + +% Define \newwrite to be identical to plain tex's \newwrite +% except not \outer, so it can be used within \newindex. +{\catcode`\@=11 +\gdef\newwrite{\alloc@7\write\chardef\sixt@@n}} + +% \newindex {foo} defines an index named foo. +% It automatically defines \fooindex such that +% \fooindex ...rest of line... puts an entry in the index foo. +% It also defines \fooindfile to be the number of the output channel for +% the file that accumulates this index. The file's extension is foo. +% The name of an index should be no more than 2 characters long +% for the sake of vms. +% +\def\newindex#1{% + \iflinks + \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname + \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1 % Open the file + \fi + \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% % Define @#1index + \noexpand\doindex{#1}} +} + +% @defindex foo == \newindex{foo} +% +\def\defindex{\parsearg\newindex} + +% Define @defcodeindex, like @defindex except put all entries in @code. +% +\def\defcodeindex{\parsearg\newcodeindex} +% +\def\newcodeindex#1{% + \iflinks + \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname + \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1 + \fi + \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% + \noexpand\docodeindex{#1}}% +} + + +% @synindex foo bar makes index foo feed into index bar. +% Do this instead of @defindex foo if you don't want it as a separate index. +% +% @syncodeindex foo bar similar, but put all entries made for index foo +% inside @code. +% +\def\synindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\doindex{#1}{#2}} +\def\syncodeindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\docodeindex{#1}{#2}} + +% #1 is \doindex or \docodeindex, #2 the index getting redefined (foo), +% #3 the target index (bar). +\def\dosynindex#1#2#3{% + % Only do \closeout if we haven't already done it, else we'll end up + % closing the target index. + \expandafter \ifx\csname donesynindex#2\endcsname \undefined + % The \closeout helps reduce unnecessary open files; the limit on the + % Acorn RISC OS is a mere 16 files. + \expandafter\closeout\csname#2indfile\endcsname + \expandafter\let\csname\donesynindex#2\endcsname = 1 + \fi + % redefine \fooindfile: + \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp\expandafter=\csname#3indfile\endcsname + \expandafter\let\csname#2indfile\endcsname=\temp + % redefine \fooindex: + \expandafter\xdef\csname#2index\endcsname{\noexpand#1{#3}}% +} + +% Define \doindex, the driver for all \fooindex macros. +% Argument #1 is generated by the calling \fooindex macro, +% and it is "foo", the name of the index. + +% \doindex just uses \parsearg; it calls \doind for the actual work. +% This is because \doind is more useful to call from other macros. + +% There is also \dosubind {index}{topic}{subtopic} +% which makes an entry in a two-level index such as the operation index. + +\def\doindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singleindexer} +\def\singleindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{#1}} + +% like the previous two, but they put @code around the argument. +\def\docodeindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singlecodeindexer} +\def\singlecodeindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{\code{#1}}} + +% Take care of Texinfo commands that can appear in an index entry. +% Since there are some commands we want to expand, and others we don't, +% we have to laboriously prevent expansion for those that we don't. +% +\def\indexdummies{% + \def\@{@}% change to @@ when we switch to @ as escape char in index files. + \def\ {\realbackslash\space }% + % Need these in case \tex is in effect and \{ is a \delimiter again. + % But can't use \lbracecmd and \rbracecmd because texindex assumes + % braces and backslashes are used only as delimiters. + \let\{ = \mylbrace + \let\} = \myrbrace + % + % \definedummyword defines \#1 as \realbackslash #1\space, thus + % effectively preventing its expansion. This is used only for control + % words, not control letters, because the \space would be incorrect + % for control characters, but is needed to separate the control word + % from whatever follows. + % + % For control letters, we have \definedummyletter, which omits the + % space. + % + % These can be used both for control words that take an argument and + % those that do not. If it is followed by {arg} in the input, then + % that will dutifully get written to the index (or wherever). + % + \def\definedummyword##1{% + \expandafter\def\csname ##1\endcsname{\realbackslash ##1\space}% + }% + \def\definedummyletter##1{% + \expandafter\def\csname ##1\endcsname{\realbackslash ##1}% + }% + % + % Do the redefinitions. + \commondummies +} + +% For the aux file, @ is the escape character. So we want to redefine +% everything using @ instead of \realbackslash. When everything uses +% @, this will be simpler. +% +\def\atdummies{% + \def\@{@@}% + \def\ {@ }% + \let\{ = \lbraceatcmd + \let\} = \rbraceatcmd + % + % (See comments in \indexdummies.) + \def\definedummyword##1{% + \expandafter\def\csname ##1\endcsname{@##1\space}% + }% + \def\definedummyletter##1{% + \expandafter\def\csname ##1\endcsname{@##1}% + }% + % + % Do the redefinitions. + \commondummies +} + +% Called from \indexdummies and \atdummies. \definedummyword and +% \definedummyletter must be defined first. +% +\def\commondummies{% + % + \normalturnoffactive + % + % Control letters and accents. + \definedummyletter{_}% + \definedummyletter{,}% + \definedummyletter{"}% + \definedummyletter{`}% + \definedummyletter{'}% + \definedummyletter{^}% + \definedummyletter{~}% + \definedummyletter{=}% + \definedummyword{u}% + \definedummyword{v}% + \definedummyword{H}% + \definedummyword{dotaccent}% + \definedummyword{ringaccent}% + \definedummyword{tieaccent}% + \definedummyword{ubaraccent}% + \definedummyword{udotaccent}% + \definedummyword{dotless}% + % + % Other non-English letters. + \definedummyword{AA}% + \definedummyword{AE}% + \definedummyword{L}% + \definedummyword{OE}% + \definedummyword{O}% + \definedummyword{aa}% + \definedummyword{ae}% + \definedummyword{l}% + \definedummyword{oe}% + \definedummyword{o}% + \definedummyword{ss}% + % + % Although these internal commands shouldn't show up, sometimes they do. + \definedummyword{bf}% + \definedummyword{gtr}% + \definedummyword{hat}% + \definedummyword{less}% + \definedummyword{sf}% + \definedummyword{sl}% + \definedummyword{tclose}% + \definedummyword{tt}% + % + % Texinfo font commands. + \definedummyword{b}% + \definedummyword{i}% + \definedummyword{r}% + \definedummyword{sc}% + \definedummyword{t}% + % + \definedummyword{TeX}% + \definedummyword{acronym}% + \definedummyword{cite}% + \definedummyword{code}% + \definedummyword{command}% + \definedummyword{dfn}% + \definedummyword{dots}% + \definedummyword{emph}% + \definedummyword{env}% + \definedummyword{file}% + \definedummyword{kbd}% + \definedummyword{key}% + \definedummyword{math}% + \definedummyword{option}% + \definedummyword{samp}% + \definedummyword{strong}% + \definedummyword{uref}% + \definedummyword{url}% + \definedummyword{var}% + \definedummyword{verb}% + \definedummyword{w}% + % + % Assorted special characters. + \definedummyword{bullet}% + \definedummyword{copyright}% + \definedummyword{dots}% + \definedummyword{enddots}% + \definedummyword{equiv}% + \definedummyword{error}% + \definedummyword{expansion}% + \definedummyword{minus}% + \definedummyword{pounds}% + \definedummyword{point}% + \definedummyword{print}% + \definedummyword{result}% + % + % Handle some cases of @value -- where the variable name does not + % contain - or _, and the value does not contain any + % (non-fully-expandable) commands. + \let\value = \expandablevalue + % + % Normal spaces, not active ones. + \unsepspaces + % + % No macro expansion. + \turnoffmacros +} + +% If an index command is used in an @example environment, any spaces +% therein should become regular spaces in the raw index file, not the +% expansion of \tie (\leavevmode \penalty \@M \ ). +{\obeyspaces + \gdef\unsepspaces{\obeyspaces\let =\space}} + + +% \indexnofonts is used when outputting the strings to sort the index +% by, and when constructing control sequence names. It eliminates all +% control sequences and just writes whatever the best ASCII sort string +% would be for a given command (usually its argument). +% +\def\indexdummytex{TeX} +\def\indexdummydots{...} +% +\def\indexnofonts{% + \def\ { }% + \def\@{@}% + % how to handle braces? + \def\_{\normalunderscore}% + % + \let\,=\asis + \let\"=\asis + \let\`=\asis + \let\'=\asis + \let\^=\asis + \let\~=\asis + \let\==\asis + \let\u=\asis + \let\v=\asis + \let\H=\asis + \let\dotaccent=\asis + \let\ringaccent=\asis + \let\tieaccent=\asis + \let\ubaraccent=\asis + \let\udotaccent=\asis + \let\dotless=\asis + % + % Other non-English letters. + \def\AA{AA}% + \def\AE{AE}% + \def\L{L}% + \def\OE{OE}% + \def\O{O}% + \def\aa{aa}% + \def\ae{ae}% + \def\l{l}% + \def\oe{oe}% + \def\o{o}% + \def\ss{ss}% + \def\exclamdown{!}% + \def\questiondown{?}% + % + % Don't no-op \tt, since it isn't a user-level command + % and is used in the definitions of the active chars like <, >, |, etc. + % Likewise with the other plain tex font commands. + %\let\tt=\asis + % + % Texinfo font commands. + \let\b=\asis + \let\i=\asis + \let\r=\asis + \let\sc=\asis + \let\t=\asis + % + \let\TeX=\indexdummytex + \let\acronym=\asis + \let\cite=\asis + \let\code=\asis + \let\command=\asis + \let\dfn=\asis + \let\dots=\indexdummydots + \let\emph=\asis + \let\env=\asis + \let\file=\asis + \let\kbd=\asis + \let\key=\asis + \let\math=\asis + \let\option=\asis + \let\samp=\asis + \let\strong=\asis + \let\uref=\asis + \let\url=\asis + \let\var=\asis + \let\verb=\asis + \let\w=\asis +} \let\indexbackslash=0 %overridden during \printindex. +\let\SETmarginindex=\relax % put index entries in margin (undocumented)? -\let\SETmarginindex=\relax %initialize! -% workhorse for all \fooindexes -% #1 is name of index, #2 is stuff to put there -\def\doind #1#2{% -% Put the index entry in the margin if desired. -\ifx\SETmarginindex\relax\else% -\insert\margin{\hbox{\vrule height8pt depth3pt width0pt #2}}% -\fi% -{\count10=\lastpenalty % -{\indexdummies % Must do this here, since \bf, etc expand at this stage -\escapechar=`\\% -{\let\folio=0% Expand all macros now EXCEPT \folio -\def\rawbackslashxx{\indexbackslash}% \indexbackslash isn't defined now -% so it will be output as is; and it will print as backslash in the indx. -% -% Now process the index-string once, with all font commands turned off, -% to get the string to sort the index by. -{\indexnofonts -\xdef\temp1{#2}% -}% -% Now produce the complete index entry. We process the index-string again, -% this time with font commands expanded, to get what to print in the index. -\edef\temp{% -\write \csname#1indfile\endcsname{% -\realbackslash entry {\temp1}{\folio}{#2}}}% -\temp }% -}\penalty\count10}} - -\def\dosubind #1#2#3{% -{\count10=\lastpenalty % -{\indexdummies % Must do this here, since \bf, etc expand at this stage -\escapechar=`\\% -{\let\folio=0% -\def\rawbackslashxx{\indexbackslash}% -% -% Now process the index-string once, with all font commands turned off, -% to get the string to sort the index by. -{\indexnofonts -\xdef\temp1{#2 #3}% -}% -% Now produce the complete index entry. We process the index-string again, -% this time with font commands expanded, to get what to print in the index. -\edef\temp{% -\write \csname#1indfile\endcsname{% -\realbackslash entry {\temp1}{\folio}{#2}{#3}}}% -\temp }% -}\penalty\count10}} +% Most index entries go through here, but \dosubind is the general case. +% +\def\doind#1#2{\dosubind{#1}{#2}{}} + +% Workhorse for all \fooindexes. +% #1 is name of index, #2 is stuff to put there, #3 is subentry -- +% \empty if called from \doind, as we usually are. The main exception +% is with defuns, which call us directly. +% +\def\dosubind#1#2#3{% + \iflinks + {% + % Store the main index entry text (including the third arg). + \toks0 = {#2}% + % If third arg is present, precede it with space. + \def\thirdarg{#3}% + \ifx\thirdarg\empty \else + \toks0 = \expandafter{\the\toks0 \space #3}% + \fi + % + \edef\writeto{\csname#1indfile\endcsname}% + % + \ifvmode + \dosubindsanitize + \else + \dosubindwrite + \fi + }% + \fi +} + +% Write the entry to the index file: +% +\def\dosubindwrite{% + % Put the index entry in the margin if desired. + \ifx\SETmarginindex\relax\else + \insert\margin{\hbox{\vrule height8pt depth3pt width0pt \the\toks0}}% + \fi + % + % Remember, we are within a group. + \indexdummies % Must do this here, since \bf, etc expand at this stage + \escapechar=`\\ + \def\rawbackslashxx{\indexbackslash}% \indexbackslash isn't defined now + % so it will be output as is; and it will print as backslash. + % + % Process the index entry with all font commands turned off, to + % get the string to sort by. + {\indexnofonts + \edef\temp{\the\toks0}% need full expansion + \xdef\indexsorttmp{\temp}% + }% + % + % Set up the complete index entry, with both the sort key and + % the original text, including any font commands. We write + % three arguments to \entry to the .?? file (four in the + % subentry case), texindex reduces to two when writing the .??s + % sorted result. + \edef\temp{% + \write\writeto{% + \string\entry{\indexsorttmp}{\noexpand\folio}{\the\toks0}}% + }% + \temp +} + +% Take care of unwanted page breaks: +% +% If a skip is the last thing on the list now, preserve it +% by backing up by \lastskip, doing the \write, then inserting +% the skip again. Otherwise, the whatsit generated by the +% \write will make \lastskip zero. The result is that sequences +% like this: +% @end defun +% @tindex whatever +% @defun ... +% will have extra space inserted, because the \medbreak in the +% start of the @defun won't see the skip inserted by the @end of +% the previous defun. +% +% But don't do any of this if we're not in vertical mode. We +% don't want to do a \vskip and prematurely end a paragraph. +% +% Avoid page breaks due to these extra skips, too. +% +\def\dosubindsanitize{% + % \lastskip and \lastpenalty cannot both be nonzero simultaneously. + \skip0 = \lastskip + \count255 = \lastpenalty + % + % If \lastskip is nonzero, that means the last item was a + % skip. And since a skip is discardable, that means this + % -\skip0 glue we're inserting is preceded by a + % non-discardable item, therefore it is not a potential + % breakpoint, therefore no \nobreak needed. + \ifdim\lastskip = 0pt \else \vskip-\skip0 \fi + % + \dosubindwrite + % + \ifdim\skip0 = 0pt + % if \lastskip was zero, perhaps the last item was a + % penalty, and perhaps it was >=10000, e.g., a \nobreak. + % In that case, we want to re-insert the penalty; since we + % just inserted a non-discardable item, any following glue + % (such as a \parskip) would be a breakpoint. For example: + % @deffn deffn-whatever + % @vindex index-whatever + % Description. + % would allow a break between the index-whatever whatsit + % and the "Description." paragraph. + \ifnum\count255>9999 \nobreak \fi + \else + % On the other hand, if we had a nonzero \lastskip, + % this make-up glue would be preceded by a non-discardable item + % (the whatsit from the \write), so we must insert a \nobreak. + \nobreak\vskip\skip0 + \fi +} % The index entry written in the file actually looks like % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic} @@ -2134,78 +3293,86 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi % Define the macros used in formatting output of the sorted index material. -% This is what you call to cause a particular index to get printed. -% Write -% @unnumbered Function Index -% @printindex fn - +% @printindex causes a particular index (the ??s file) to get printed. +% It does not print any chapter heading (usually an @unnumbered). +% \def\printindex{\parsearg\doprintindex} - -\def\doprintindex#1{% - \tex - \dobreak \chapheadingskip {10000} - \catcode`\%=\other\catcode`\&=\other\catcode`\#=\other - \catcode`\$=\other - \catcode`\~=\other - \indexbreaks +\def\doprintindex#1{\begingroup + \dobreak \chapheadingskip{10000}% % - % The following don't help, since the chars were translated - % when the raw index was written, and their fonts were discarded - % due to \indexnofonts. - %\catcode`\"=\active - %\catcode`\^=\active - %\catcode`\_=\active - %\catcode`\|=\active - %\catcode`\<=\active - %\catcode`\>=\active - % % - \def\indexbackslash{\rawbackslashxx} - \indexfonts\rm \tolerance=9500 \advance\baselineskip -1pt - \begindoublecolumns + \smallfonts \rm + \tolerance = 9500 + \everypar = {}% don't want the \kern\-parindent from indentation suppression. + \indexbreaks % % See if the index file exists and is nonempty. + % Change catcode of @ here so that if the index file contains + % \initial {@} + % as its first line, TeX doesn't complain about mismatched braces + % (because it thinks @} is a control sequence). + \catcode`\@ = 11 \openin 1 \jobname.#1s \ifeof 1 % \enddoublecolumns gets confused if there is no text in the index, % and it loses the chapter title and the aux file entries for the % index. The easiest way to prevent this problem is to make sure % there is some text. - (Index is nonexistent) - \else + \putwordIndexNonexistent + \else % % If the index file exists but is empty, then \openin leaves \ifeof % false. We have to make TeX try to read something from the file, so % it can discover if there is anything in it. \read 1 to \temp \ifeof 1 - (Index is empty) + \putwordIndexIsEmpty \else + % Index files are almost Texinfo source, but we use \ as the escape + % character. It would be better to use @, but that's too big a change + % to make right now. + \def\indexbackslash{\rawbackslashxx}% + \catcode`\\ = 0 + \escapechar = `\\ + \begindoublecolumns \input \jobname.#1s + \enddoublecolumns \fi \fi \closein 1 - \enddoublecolumns - \Etex -} +\endgroup} % These macros are used by the sorted index file itself. % Change them to control the appearance of the index. -% Same as \bigskipamount except no shrink. -% \balancecolumns gets confused if there is any shrink. -\newskip\initialskipamount \initialskipamount 12pt plus4pt - -\def\initial #1{% -{\let\tentt=\sectt \let\tt=\sectt \let\sf=\sectt -\ifdim\lastskip<\initialskipamount -\removelastskip \penalty-200 \vskip \initialskipamount\fi -\line{\secbf#1\hfill}\kern 2pt\penalty10000}} +\def\initial#1{{% + % Some minor font changes for the special characters. + \let\tentt=\sectt \let\tt=\sectt \let\sf=\sectt + % + % Remove any glue we may have, we'll be inserting our own. + \removelastskip + % + % We like breaks before the index initials, so insert a bonus. + \penalty -300 + % + % Typeset the initial. Making this add up to a whole number of + % baselineskips increases the chance of the dots lining up from column + % to column. It still won't often be perfect, because of the stretch + % we need before each entry, but it's better. + % + % No shrink because it confuses \balancecolumns. + \vskip 1.67\baselineskip plus .5\baselineskip + \leftline{\secbf #1}% + \vskip .33\baselineskip plus .1\baselineskip + % + % Do our best not to break after the initial. + \nobreak +}} % This typesets a paragraph consisting of #1, dot leaders, and then #2 % flush to the right margin. It is used for index and table of contents % entries. The paragraph is indented by \leftskip. % -\def\entry #1#2{\begingroup +\def\entry#1#2{\begingroup % % Start a new paragraph if necessary, so our assignments below can't % affect previous text. @@ -2228,19 +3395,22 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi % % \hangafter is reset to 1 (which is the value we want) at the start % of each paragraph, so we need not do anything with that. - \hangindent=2em + \hangindent = 2em % % When the entry text needs to be broken, just fill out the first line % with blank space. \rightskip = 0pt plus1fil % + % A bit of stretch before each entry for the benefit of balancing columns. + \vskip 0pt plus1pt + % % Start a ``paragraph'' for the index entry so the line breaking % parameters we've set above will have an effect. \noindent % % Insert the text of the index entry. TeX will do line-breaking on it. #1% - % The following is kluged to not output a line of dots in the index if + % The following is kludged to not output a line of dots in the index if % there are no page numbers. The next person who breaks this will be % cursed by a Unix daemon. \def\tempa{{\rm }}% @@ -2258,7 +3428,11 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi % The `\ ' here is removed by the implicit \unskip that TeX does as % part of (the primitive) \par. Without it, a spurious underfull % \hbox ensues. - \ #2% The page number ends the paragraph. + \ifpdf + \pdfgettoks#2.\ \the\toksA % The page number ends the paragraph. + \else + \ #2% The page number ends the paragraph. + \fi \fi% \par \endgroup} @@ -2270,41 +3444,65 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi \def\primary #1{\line{#1\hfil}} \newskip\secondaryindent \secondaryindent=0.5cm - -\def\secondary #1#2{ -{\parfillskip=0in \parskip=0in -\hangindent =1in \hangafter=1 -\noindent\hskip\secondaryindent\hbox{#1}\indexdotfill #2\par +\def\secondary#1#2{{% + \parfillskip=0in + \parskip=0in + \hangindent=1in + \hangafter=1 + \noindent\hskip\secondaryindent\hbox{#1}\indexdotfill + \ifpdf + \pdfgettoks#2.\ \the\toksA % The page number ends the paragraph. + \else + #2 + \fi + \par }} -%% Define two-column mode, which is used in indexes. -%% Adapted from the TeXbook, page 416. -\catcode `\@=11 +% Define two-column mode, which we use to typeset indexes. +% Adapted from the TeXbook, page 416, which is to say, +% the manmac.tex format used to print the TeXbook itself. +\catcode`\@=11 \newbox\partialpage - \newdimen\doublecolumnhsize -\def\begindoublecolumns{\begingroup +\def\begindoublecolumns{\begingroup % ended by \enddoublecolumns % Grab any single-column material above us. - \output = {\global\setbox\partialpage - =\vbox{\unvbox255\kern -\topskip \kern \baselineskip}}% - \eject + \output = {% + % + % Here is a possibility not foreseen in manmac: if we accumulate a + % whole lot of material, we might end up calling this \output + % routine twice in a row (see the doublecol-lose test, which is + % essentially a couple of indexes with @setchapternewpage off). In + % that case we just ship out what is in \partialpage with the normal + % output routine. Generally, \partialpage will be empty when this + % runs and this will be a no-op. See the indexspread.tex test case. + \ifvoid\partialpage \else + \onepageout{\pagecontents\partialpage}% + \fi + % + \global\setbox\partialpage = \vbox{% + % Unvbox the main output page. + \unvbox\PAGE + \kern-\topskip \kern\baselineskip + }% + }% + \eject % run that output routine to set \partialpage % - % Now switch to the double-column output routine. - \output={\doublecolumnout}% + % Use the double-column output routine for subsequent pages. + \output = {\doublecolumnout}% % % Change the page size parameters. We could do this once outside this % routine, in each of @smallbook, @afourpaper, and the default 8.5x11 % format, but then we repeat the same computation. Repeating a couple % of assignments once per index is clearly meaningless for the - % execution time, so we may as well do it once. + % execution time, so we may as well do it in one place. % % First we halve the line length, less a little for the gutter between % the columns. We compute the gutter based on the line length, so it % changes automatically with the paper format. The magic constant - % below is chosen so that the gutter has the same value (well, +- < - % 1pt) as it did when we hard-coded it. + % below is chosen so that the gutter has the same value (well, +-<1pt) + % as it did when we hard-coded it. % % We put the result in a separate register, \doublecolumhsize, so we % can restore it in \pagesofar, after \hsize itself has (potentially) @@ -2318,111 +3516,156 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi % Double the \vsize as well. (We don't need a separate register here, % since nobody clobbers \vsize.) \vsize = 2\vsize - \doublecolumnpagegoal } -\def\enddoublecolumns{\eject \endgroup \pagegoal=\vsize \unvbox\partialpage} - -\def\doublecolumnsplit{\splittopskip=\topskip \splitmaxdepth=\maxdepth - \global\dimen@=\pageheight \global\advance\dimen@ by-\ht\partialpage - \global\setbox1=\vsplit255 to\dimen@ \global\setbox0=\vbox{\unvbox1} - \global\setbox3=\vsplit255 to\dimen@ \global\setbox2=\vbox{\unvbox3} - \ifdim\ht0>\dimen@ \setbox255=\vbox{\unvbox0\unvbox2} \global\setbox255=\copy5 \fi - \ifdim\ht2>\dimen@ \setbox255=\vbox{\unvbox0\unvbox2} \global\setbox255=\copy5 \fi +% The double-column output routine for all double-column pages except +% the last. +% +\def\doublecolumnout{% + \splittopskip=\topskip \splitmaxdepth=\maxdepth + % Get the available space for the double columns -- the normal + % (undoubled) page height minus any material left over from the + % previous page. + \dimen@ = \vsize + \divide\dimen@ by 2 + \advance\dimen@ by -\ht\partialpage + % + % box0 will be the left-hand column, box2 the right. + \setbox0=\vsplit255 to\dimen@ \setbox2=\vsplit255 to\dimen@ + \onepageout\pagesofar + \unvbox255 + \penalty\outputpenalty } -\def\doublecolumnpagegoal{% - \dimen@=\vsize \advance\dimen@ by-2\ht\partialpage \global\pagegoal=\dimen@ +% +% Re-output the contents of the output page -- any previous material, +% followed by the two boxes we just split, in box0 and box2. +\def\pagesofar{% + \unvbox\partialpage + % + \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize + \wd0=\hsize \wd2=\hsize + \hbox to\pagewidth{\box0\hfil\box2}% } -\def\pagesofar{\unvbox\partialpage % - \hsize=\doublecolumnhsize % have to restore this since output routine - \wd0=\hsize \wd2=\hsize \hbox to\pagewidth{\box0\hfil\box2}} -\def\doublecolumnout{% - \setbox5=\copy255 - {\vbadness=10000 \doublecolumnsplit} - \ifvbox255 - \setbox0=\vtop to\dimen@{\unvbox0} - \setbox2=\vtop to\dimen@{\unvbox2} - \onepageout\pagesofar \unvbox255 \penalty\outputpenalty - \else - \setbox0=\vbox{\unvbox5} - \ifvbox0 - \dimen@=\ht0 \advance\dimen@ by\topskip \advance\dimen@ by-\baselineskip - \divide\dimen@ by2 \splittopskip=\topskip \splitmaxdepth=\maxdepth - {\vbadness=10000 - \loop \global\setbox5=\copy0 - \setbox1=\vsplit5 to\dimen@ - \setbox3=\vsplit5 to\dimen@ - \ifvbox5 \global\advance\dimen@ by1pt \repeat - \setbox0=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox1} - \setbox2=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox3} - \global\setbox\partialpage=\vbox{\pagesofar} - \doublecolumnpagegoal - } - \fi - \fi +% +% All done with double columns. +\def\enddoublecolumns{% + \output = {% + % Split the last of the double-column material. Leave it on the + % current page, no automatic page break. + \balancecolumns + % + % If we end up splitting too much material for the current page, + % though, there will be another page break right after this \output + % invocation ends. Having called \balancecolumns once, we do not + % want to call it again. Therefore, reset \output to its normal + % definition right away. (We hope \balancecolumns will never be + % called on to balance too much material, but if it is, this makes + % the output somewhat more palatable.) + \global\output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}% + }% + \eject + \endgroup % started in \begindoublecolumns + % + % \pagegoal was set to the doubled \vsize above, since we restarted + % the current page. We're now back to normal single-column + % typesetting, so reset \pagegoal to the normal \vsize (after the + % \endgroup where \vsize got restored). + \pagegoal = \vsize } +% +% Called at the end of the double column material. +\def\balancecolumns{% + \setbox0 = \vbox{\unvbox255}% like \box255 but more efficient, see p.120. + \dimen@ = \ht0 + \advance\dimen@ by \topskip + \advance\dimen@ by-\baselineskip + \divide\dimen@ by 2 % target to split to + %debug\message{final 2-column material height=\the\ht0, target=\the\dimen@.}% + \splittopskip = \topskip + % Loop until we get a decent breakpoint. + {% + \vbadness = 10000 + \loop + \global\setbox3 = \copy0 + \global\setbox1 = \vsplit3 to \dimen@ + \ifdim\ht3>\dimen@ + \global\advance\dimen@ by 1pt + \repeat + }% + %debug\message{split to \the\dimen@, column heights: \the\ht1, \the\ht3.}% + \setbox0=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox1}% + \setbox2=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox3}% + % + \pagesofar +} +\catcode`\@ = \other -\catcode `\@=\other -\message{sectioning,} -% Define chapters, sections, etc. -\newcount \chapno -\newcount \secno \secno=0 -\newcount \subsecno \subsecno=0 -\newcount \subsubsecno \subsubsecno=0 +\message{sectioning,} +% Chapters, sections, etc. + +% \unnumberedno is an oxymoron, of course. But we count the unnumbered +% sections so that we can refer to them unambiguously in the pdf +% outlines by their "section number". We avoid collisions with chapter +% numbers by starting them at 10000. (If a document ever has 10000 +% chapters, we're in trouble anyway, I'm sure.) +\newcount\unnumberedno \unnumberedno = 10000 +\newcount\chapno +\newcount\secno \secno=0 +\newcount\subsecno \subsecno=0 +\newcount\subsubsecno \subsubsecno=0 % This counter is funny since it counts through charcodes of letters A, B, ... -\newcount \appendixno \appendixno = `\@ -\def\appendixletter{\char\the\appendixno} - -\newwrite \contentsfile -% This is called from \setfilename. -\def\opencontents{\openout \contentsfile = \jobname.toc} +\newcount\appendixno \appendixno = `\@ +% +% \def\appendixletter{\char\the\appendixno} +% We do the following ugly conditional instead of the above simple +% construct for the sake of pdftex, which needs the actual +% letter in the expansion, not just typeset. +% +\def\appendixletter{% + \ifnum\appendixno=`A A% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`B B% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`C C% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`D D% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`E E% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`F F% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`G G% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`H H% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`I I% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`J J% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`K K% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`L L% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`M M% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`N N% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`O O% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`P P% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Q Q% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`R R% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`S S% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`T T% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`U U% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`V V% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`W W% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`X X% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Y Y% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Z Z% + % The \the is necessary, despite appearances, because \appendixletter is + % expanded while writing the .toc file. \char\appendixno is not + % expandable, thus it is written literally, thus all appendixes come out + % with the same letter (or @) in the toc without it. + \else\char\the\appendixno + \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi + \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi} % Each @chapter defines this as the name of the chapter. -% page headings and footings can use it. @section does likewise - -\def\thischapter{} \def\thissection{} -\def\seccheck#1{\if \pageno<0 % -\errmessage{@#1 not allowed after generating table of contents}\fi -% -} - -\def\chapternofonts{% -\let\rawbackslash=\relax% -\let\frenchspacing=\relax% -\def\result{\realbackslash result} -\def\equiv{\realbackslash equiv} -\def\expansion{\realbackslash expansion} -\def\print{\realbackslash print} -\def\TeX{\realbackslash TeX} -\def\dots{\realbackslash dots} -\def\copyright{\realbackslash copyright} -\def\tt{\realbackslash tt} -\def\bf{\realbackslash bf } -\def\w{\realbackslash w} -\def\less{\realbackslash less} -\def\gtr{\realbackslash gtr} -\def\hat{\realbackslash hat} -\def\char{\realbackslash char} -\def\tclose##1{\realbackslash tclose {##1}} -\def\code##1{\realbackslash code {##1}} -\def\samp##1{\realbackslash samp {##1}} -\def\r##1{\realbackslash r {##1}} -\def\b##1{\realbackslash b {##1}} -\def\key##1{\realbackslash key {##1}} -\def\file##1{\realbackslash file {##1}} -\def\kbd##1{\realbackslash kbd {##1}} -% These are redefined because @smartitalic wouldn't work inside xdef. -\def\i##1{\realbackslash i {##1}} -\def\cite##1{\realbackslash cite {##1}} -\def\var##1{\realbackslash var {##1}} -\def\emph##1{\realbackslash emph {##1}} -\def\dfn##1{\realbackslash dfn {##1}} -} +% page headings and footings can use it. @section does likewise. +% However, they are not reliable, because we don't use marks. +\def\thischapter{} +\def\thissection{} \newcount\absseclevel % used to calculate proper heading level -\newcount\secbase\secbase=0 % @raise/lowersections modify this count +\newcount\secbase\secbase=0 % @raisesections/@lowersections modify this count % @raisesections: treat @section as chapter, @subsection as section, etc. \def\raisesections{\global\advance\secbase by -1} @@ -2437,261 +3680,183 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi % #2 is text for heading \def\numhead#1#2{\absseclevel=\secbase\advance\absseclevel by #1 \ifcase\absseclevel - \chapterzzz{#2} -\or - \seczzz{#2} -\or - \numberedsubseczzz{#2} -\or - \numberedsubsubseczzz{#2} -\else - \ifnum \absseclevel<0 - \chapterzzz{#2} + \chapterzzz{#2}% + \or \seczzz{#2}% + \or \numberedsubseczzz{#2}% + \or \numberedsubsubseczzz{#2}% \else - \numberedsubsubseczzz{#2} + \ifnum \absseclevel<0 \chapterzzz{#2}% + \else \numberedsubsubseczzz{#2}% + \fi \fi -\fi + \suppressfirstparagraphindent } % like \numhead, but chooses appendix heading levels \def\apphead#1#2{\absseclevel=\secbase\advance\absseclevel by #1 \ifcase\absseclevel - \appendixzzz{#2} -\or - \appendixsectionzzz{#2} -\or - \appendixsubseczzz{#2} -\or - \appendixsubsubseczzz{#2} -\else - \ifnum \absseclevel<0 - \appendixzzz{#2} + \appendixzzz{#2}% + \or \appendixsectionzzz{#2}% + \or \appendixsubseczzz{#2}% + \or \appendixsubsubseczzz{#2}% \else - \appendixsubsubseczzz{#2} + \ifnum \absseclevel<0 \appendixzzz{#2}% + \else \appendixsubsubseczzz{#2}% + \fi \fi -\fi + \suppressfirstparagraphindent } % like \numhead, but chooses numberless heading levels \def\unnmhead#1#2{\absseclevel=\secbase\advance\absseclevel by #1 -\ifcase\absseclevel - \unnumberedzzz{#2} -\or - \unnumberedseczzz{#2} -\or - \unnumberedsubseczzz{#2} -\or - \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#2} -\else - \ifnum \absseclevel<0 - \unnumberedzzz{#2} + \ifcase\absseclevel + \unnumberedzzz{#2}% + \or \unnumberedseczzz{#2}% + \or \unnumberedsubseczzz{#2}% + \or \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#2}% \else - \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#2} + \ifnum \absseclevel<0 \unnumberedzzz{#2}% + \else \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#2}% + \fi \fi -\fi + \suppressfirstparagraphindent } - -\def\thischaptername{No Chapter Title} +% @chapter, @appendix, @unnumbered. +% \outer\def\chapter{\parsearg\chapteryyy} -\def\chapteryyy #1{\numhead0{#1}} % normally numhead0 calls chapterzzz -\def\chapterzzz #1{\seccheck{chapter}% -\secno=0 \subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0 -\global\advance \chapno by 1 \message{\putwordChapter \the\chapno}% -\chapmacro {#1}{\the\chapno}% -\gdef\thissection{#1}% -\gdef\thischaptername{#1}% -% We don't substitute the actual chapter name into \thischapter -% because we don't want its macros evaluated now. -\xdef\thischapter{\putwordChapter{} \the\chapno: \noexpand\thischaptername}% -{\chapternofonts% -\edef\temp{{\realbackslash chapentry {#1}{\the\chapno}{\noexpand\folio}}}% -\escapechar=`\\% -\write \contentsfile \temp % -\donoderef % -\global\let\section = \numberedsec -\global\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec -\global\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec -}} +\def\chapteryyy#1{\numhead0{#1}} % normally numhead0 calls chapterzzz +\def\chapterzzz#1{% + \secno=0 \subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0 \advance\chapno by 1 + \message{\putwordChapter\space \the\chapno}% + % + % Write the actual heading. + \chapmacro{#1}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno}% + % + % So @section and the like are numbered underneath this chapter. + \global\let\section = \numberedsec + \global\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec + \global\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec +} \outer\def\appendix{\parsearg\appendixyyy} -\def\appendixyyy #1{\apphead0{#1}} % normally apphead0 calls appendixzzz -\def\appendixzzz #1{\seccheck{appendix}% -\secno=0 \subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0 -\global\advance \appendixno by 1 \message{Appendix \appendixletter}% -\chapmacro {#1}{\putwordAppendix{} \appendixletter}% -\gdef\thissection{#1}% -\gdef\thischaptername{#1}% -\xdef\thischapter{\putwordAppendix{} \appendixletter: \noexpand\thischaptername}% -{\chapternofonts% -\edef\temp{{\realbackslash chapentry - {#1}{\putwordAppendix{} \appendixletter}{\noexpand\folio}}}% -\escapechar=`\\% -\write \contentsfile \temp % -\appendixnoderef % -\global\let\section = \appendixsec -\global\let\subsection = \appendixsubsec -\global\let\subsubsection = \appendixsubsubsec -}} +\def\appendixyyy#1{\apphead0{#1}} % normally apphead0 calls appendixzzz +\def\appendixzzz#1{% + \secno=0 \subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0 \advance\appendixno by 1 + \def\appendixnum{\putwordAppendix\space \appendixletter}% + \message{\appendixnum}% + \chapmacro{#1}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter}% + \global\let\section = \appendixsec + \global\let\subsection = \appendixsubsec + \global\let\subsubsection = \appendixsubsubsec +} +% @centerchap is like @unnumbered, but the heading is centered. +\outer\def\centerchap{\parsearg\centerchapyyy} +\def\centerchapyyy#1{{\unnumberedyyy{#1}}} + +% @top is like @unnumbered. \outer\def\top{\parsearg\unnumberedyyy} + \outer\def\unnumbered{\parsearg\unnumberedyyy} -\def\unnumberedyyy #1{\unnmhead0{#1}} % normally unnmhead0 calls unnumberedzzz -\def\unnumberedzzz #1{\seccheck{unnumbered}% -\secno=0 \subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0 -% -% This used to be simply \message{#1}, but TeX fully expands the -% argument to \message. Therefore, if #1 contained @-commands, TeX -% expanded them. For example, in `@unnumbered The @cite{Book}', TeX -% expanded @cite (which turns out to cause errors because \cite is meant -% to be executed, not expanded). -% -% Anyway, we don't want the fully-expanded definition of @cite to appear -% as a result of the \message, we just want `@cite' itself. We use -% \the to achieve this: TeX expands \the only once, -% simply yielding the contents of the . -\toks0 = {#1}\message{(\the\toks0)}% -% -\unnumbchapmacro {#1}% -\gdef\thischapter{#1}\gdef\thissection{#1}% -{\chapternofonts% -\edef\temp{{\realbackslash unnumbchapentry {#1}{\noexpand\folio}}}% -\escapechar=`\\% -\write \contentsfile \temp % -\unnumbnoderef % -\global\let\section = \unnumberedsec -\global\let\subsection = \unnumberedsubsec -\global\let\subsubsection = \unnumberedsubsubsec -}} +\def\unnumberedyyy#1{\unnmhead0{#1}} % normally unnmhead0 calls unnumberedzzz +\def\unnumberedzzz#1{% + \secno=0 \subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0 \advance\unnumberedno by 1 + % + % This used to be simply \message{#1}, but TeX fully expands the + % argument to \message. Therefore, if #1 contained @-commands, TeX + % expanded them. For example, in `@unnumbered The @cite{Book}', TeX + % expanded @cite (which turns out to cause errors because \cite is meant + % to be executed, not expanded). + % + % Anyway, we don't want the fully-expanded definition of @cite to appear + % as a result of the \message, we just want `@cite' itself. We use + % \the to achieve this: TeX expands \the only once, + % simply yielding the contents of . (We also do this for + % the toc entries.) + \toks0 = {#1}\message{(\the\toks0)}% + % + \chapmacro{#1}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno}% + % + \global\let\section = \unnumberedsec + \global\let\subsection = \unnumberedsubsec + \global\let\subsubsection = \unnumberedsubsubsec +} +% Sections. \outer\def\numberedsec{\parsearg\secyyy} -\def\secyyy #1{\numhead1{#1}} % normally calls seczzz -\def\seczzz #1{\seccheck{section}% -\subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0 \global\advance \secno by 1 % -\gdef\thissection{#1}\secheading {#1}{\the\chapno}{\the\secno}% -{\chapternofonts% -\edef\temp{{\realbackslash secentry % -{#1}{\the\chapno}{\the\secno}{\noexpand\folio}}}% -\escapechar=`\\% -\write \contentsfile \temp % -\donoderef % -\penalty 10000 % -}} +\def\secyyy#1{\numhead1{#1}} % normally calls seczzz +\def\seczzz#1{% + \subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0 \advance\secno by 1 + \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}% +} -\outer\def\appenixsection{\parsearg\appendixsecyyy} +\outer\def\appendixsection{\parsearg\appendixsecyyy} \outer\def\appendixsec{\parsearg\appendixsecyyy} -\def\appendixsecyyy #1{\apphead1{#1}} % normally calls appendixsectionzzz -\def\appendixsectionzzz #1{\seccheck{appendixsection}% -\subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0 \global\advance \secno by 1 % -\gdef\thissection{#1}\secheading {#1}{\appendixletter}{\the\secno}% -{\chapternofonts% -\edef\temp{{\realbackslash secentry % -{#1}{\appendixletter}{\the\secno}{\noexpand\folio}}}% -\escapechar=`\\% -\write \contentsfile \temp % -\appendixnoderef % -\penalty 10000 % -}} +\def\appendixsecyyy#1{\apphead1{#1}} % normally calls appendixsectionzzz +\def\appendixsectionzzz#1{% + \subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0 \advance\secno by 1 + \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter.\the\secno}% +} \outer\def\unnumberedsec{\parsearg\unnumberedsecyyy} -\def\unnumberedsecyyy #1{\unnmhead1{#1}} % normally calls unnumberedseczzz -\def\unnumberedseczzz #1{\seccheck{unnumberedsec}% -\plainsecheading {#1}\gdef\thissection{#1}% -{\chapternofonts% -\edef\temp{{\realbackslash unnumbsecentry{#1}{\noexpand\folio}}}% -\escapechar=`\\% -\write \contentsfile \temp % -\unnumbnoderef % -\penalty 10000 % -}} +\def\unnumberedsecyyy#1{\unnmhead1{#1}} % normally calls unnumberedseczzz +\def\unnumberedseczzz#1{% + \subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0 \advance\secno by 1 + \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno}% +} +% Subsections. \outer\def\numberedsubsec{\parsearg\numberedsubsecyyy} -\def\numberedsubsecyyy #1{\numhead2{#1}} % normally calls numberedsubseczzz -\def\numberedsubseczzz #1{\seccheck{subsection}% -\gdef\thissection{#1}\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance \subsecno by 1 % -\subsecheading {#1}{\the\chapno}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}% -{\chapternofonts% -\edef\temp{{\realbackslash subsecentry % -{#1}{\the\chapno}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}{\noexpand\folio}}}% -\escapechar=`\\% -\write \contentsfile \temp % -\donoderef % -\penalty 10000 % -}} +\def\numberedsubsecyyy#1{\numhead2{#1}} % normally calls numberedsubseczzz +\def\numberedsubseczzz#1{% + \subsubsecno=0 \advance\subsecno by 1 + \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}% +} \outer\def\appendixsubsec{\parsearg\appendixsubsecyyy} -\def\appendixsubsecyyy #1{\apphead2{#1}} % normally calls appendixsubseczzz -\def\appendixsubseczzz #1{\seccheck{appendixsubsec}% -\gdef\thissection{#1}\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance \subsecno by 1 % -\subsecheading {#1}{\appendixletter}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}% -{\chapternofonts% -\edef\temp{{\realbackslash subsecentry % -{#1}{\appendixletter}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}{\noexpand\folio}}}% -\escapechar=`\\% -\write \contentsfile \temp % -\appendixnoderef % -\penalty 10000 % -}} +\def\appendixsubsecyyy#1{\apphead2{#1}} % normally calls appendixsubseczzz +\def\appendixsubseczzz#1{% + \subsubsecno=0 \advance\subsecno by 1 + \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yappendix}% + {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}% +} \outer\def\unnumberedsubsec{\parsearg\unnumberedsubsecyyy} -\def\unnumberedsubsecyyy #1{\unnmhead2{#1}} %normally calls unnumberedsubseczzz -\def\unnumberedsubseczzz #1{\seccheck{unnumberedsubsec}% -\plainsecheading {#1}\gdef\thissection{#1}% -{\chapternofonts% -\edef\temp{{\realbackslash unnumbsubsecentry{#1}{\noexpand\folio}}}% -\escapechar=`\\% -\write \contentsfile \temp % -\unnumbnoderef % -\penalty 10000 % -}} +\def\unnumberedsubsecyyy#1{\unnmhead2{#1}} %normally calls unnumberedsubseczzz +\def\unnumberedsubseczzz#1{% + \subsubsecno=0 \advance\subsecno by 1 + \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynothing}% + {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}% +} +% Subsubsections. \outer\def\numberedsubsubsec{\parsearg\numberedsubsubsecyyy} -\def\numberedsubsubsecyyy #1{\numhead3{#1}} % normally numberedsubsubseczzz -\def\numberedsubsubseczzz #1{\seccheck{subsubsection}% -\gdef\thissection{#1}\global\advance \subsubsecno by 1 % -\subsubsecheading {#1} - {\the\chapno}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}{\the\subsubsecno}% -{\chapternofonts% -\edef\temp{{\realbackslash subsubsecentry % - {#1} - {\the\chapno}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}{\the\subsubsecno} - {\noexpand\folio}}}% -\escapechar=`\\% -\write \contentsfile \temp % -\donoderef % -\penalty 10000 % -}} +\def\numberedsubsubsecyyy#1{\numhead3{#1}} % normally numberedsubsubseczzz +\def\numberedsubsubseczzz#1{% + \advance\subsubsecno by 1 + \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynumbered}% + {\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}% +} \outer\def\appendixsubsubsec{\parsearg\appendixsubsubsecyyy} -\def\appendixsubsubsecyyy #1{\apphead3{#1}} % normally appendixsubsubseczzz -\def\appendixsubsubseczzz #1{\seccheck{appendixsubsubsec}% -\gdef\thissection{#1}\global\advance \subsubsecno by 1 % -\subsubsecheading {#1} - {\appendixletter}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}{\the\subsubsecno}% -{\chapternofonts% -\edef\temp{{\realbackslash subsubsecentry{#1}% - {\appendixletter} - {\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}{\the\subsubsecno}{\noexpand\folio}}}% -\escapechar=`\\% -\write \contentsfile \temp % -\appendixnoderef % -\penalty 10000 % -}} +\def\appendixsubsubsecyyy#1{\apphead3{#1}} % normally appendixsubsubseczzz +\def\appendixsubsubseczzz#1{% + \advance\subsubsecno by 1 + \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yappendix}% + {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}% +} \outer\def\unnumberedsubsubsec{\parsearg\unnumberedsubsubsecyyy} -\def\unnumberedsubsubsecyyy #1{\unnmhead3{#1}} %normally unnumberedsubsubseczzz -\def\unnumberedsubsubseczzz #1{\seccheck{unnumberedsubsubsec}% -\plainsecheading {#1}\gdef\thissection{#1}% -{\chapternofonts% -\edef\temp{{\realbackslash unnumbsubsubsecentry{#1}{\noexpand\folio}}}% -\escapechar=`\\% -\write \contentsfile \temp % -\unnumbnoderef % -\penalty 10000 % -}} +\def\unnumberedsubsubsecyyy#1{\unnmhead3{#1}} %normally unnumberedsubsubseczzz +\def\unnumberedsubsubseczzz#1{% + \advance\subsubsecno by 1 + \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynothing}% + {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}% +} % These are variants which are not "outer", so they can appear in @ifinfo. -% Actually, they should now be obsolete; ordinary section commands should work. +% Actually, they are now be obsolete; ordinary section commands should work. \def\infotop{\parsearg\unnumberedzzz} \def\infounnumbered{\parsearg\unnumberedzzz} \def\infounnumberedsec{\parsearg\unnumberedseczzz} @@ -2711,40 +3876,45 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi % These macros control what the section commands do, according % to what kind of chapter we are in (ordinary, appendix, or unnumbered). % Define them by default for a numbered chapter. -\global\let\section = \numberedsec -\global\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec -\global\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec +\let\section = \numberedsec +\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec +\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec % Define @majorheading, @heading and @subheading -% NOTE on use of \vbox for chapter headings, section headings, and -% such: -% 1) We use \vbox rather than the earlier \line to permit -% overlong headings to fold. -% 2) \hyphenpenalty is set to 10000 because hyphenation in a -% heading is obnoxious; this forbids it. +% NOTE on use of \vbox for chapter headings, section headings, and such: +% 1) We use \vbox rather than the earlier \line to permit +% overlong headings to fold. +% 2) \hyphenpenalty is set to 10000 because hyphenation in a +% heading is obnoxious; this forbids it. % 3) Likewise, headings look best if no \parindent is used, and % if justification is not attempted. Hence \raggedright. -\def\majorheading{\parsearg\majorheadingzzz} -\def\majorheadingzzz #1{% -{\advance\chapheadingskip by 10pt \chapbreak }% -{\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000 - \parindent=0pt\raggedright - \rm #1\hfill}}\bigskip \par\penalty 200} - -\def\chapheading{\parsearg\chapheadingzzz} -\def\chapheadingzzz #1{\chapbreak % -{\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000 - \parindent=0pt\raggedright - \rm #1\hfill}}\bigskip \par\penalty 200} - -\def\heading{\parsearg\secheadingi} +\def\majorheading{% + {\advance\chapheadingskip by 10pt \chapbreak }% + \parsearg\chapheadingzzz +} -\def\subheading{\parsearg\subsecheadingi} +\def\chapheading{\chapbreak \parsearg\chapheadingzzz} +\def\chapheadingzzz#1{% + {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000 + \parindent=0pt\raggedright + \rm #1\hfill}}% + \bigskip \par\penalty 200\relax + \suppressfirstparagraphindent +} -\def\subsubheading{\parsearg\subsubsecheadingi} +% @heading, @subheading, @subsubheading. +\def\heading{\parsearg\doheading} +\def\subheading{\parsearg\dosubheading} +\def\subsubheading{\parsearg\dosubsubheading} +\def\doheading#1{\sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yomitfromtoc}{} + \suppressfirstparagraphindent} +\def\dosubheading#1{\sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{} + \suppressfirstparagraphindent} +\def\dosubsubheading#1{\sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{} + \suppressfirstparagraphindent} % These macros generate a chapter, section, etc. heading only % (including whitespace, linebreaking, etc. around it), @@ -2758,7 +3928,7 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi %%% Define plain chapter starts, and page on/off switching for it % Parameter controlling skip before chapter headings (if needed) -\newskip \chapheadingskip \chapheadingskip = 30pt plus 8pt minus 4pt +\newskip\chapheadingskip \def\chapbreak{\dobreak \chapheadingskip {-4000}} \def\chappager{\par\vfill\supereject} @@ -2766,49 +3936,119 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi \def\setchapternewpage #1 {\csname CHAPPAG#1\endcsname} -\def\CHAPPAGoff{ +\def\CHAPPAGoff{% +\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapbreak \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager} -\def\CHAPPAGon{ +\def\CHAPPAGon{% +\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chappager \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSsingle}} -\def\CHAPPAGodd{ +\def\CHAPPAGodd{% +\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapoddpage \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chapoddpage \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}} \CHAPPAGon -\def\CHAPFplain{ +\def\CHAPFplain{% \global\let\chapmacro=\chfplain -\global\let\unnumbchapmacro=\unnchfplain} +\global\let\centerchapmacro=\centerchfplain} -\def\chfplain #1#2{% +% Normal chapter opening. +% +% #1 is the text, #2 is the section type (Ynumbered, Ynothing, +% Yappendix, Yomitfromtoc), #3 the chapter number. +% +% To test against our argument. +\def\Ynothingkeyword{Ynothing} +\def\Yomitfromtockeyword{Yomitfromtoc} +\def\Yappendixkeyword{Yappendix} +% +\def\chfplain#1#2#3{% \pchapsepmacro {% - \chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000 - \parindent=0pt\raggedright - \rm #2\enspace #1}% + \chapfonts \rm + % + % Have to define \thissection before calling \donoderef, because the + % xref code eventually uses it, as \Ytitle. On the other hand, it + % has to be called after \pchapsepmacro, or the headline will change + % too soon. + \gdef\thissection{#1}% + \gdef\thischaptername{#1}% + % + % Only insert the separating space if we have a chapter/appendix + % number, and don't print the unnumbered ``number''. + \def\temptype{#2}% + \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword + \setbox0 = \hbox{}% + \def\toctype{unnchap}% + \def\thischapter{#1}% + \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword + \setbox0 = \hbox{}% contents like unnumbered, but no toc entry + \def\toctype{omit}% + \xdef\thischapter{}% + \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword + \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} #3\enspace}% + \def\toctype{app}% + % We don't substitute the actual chapter name into \thischapter + % because we don't want its macros evaluated now. And we don't + % use \thissection because that changes with each section. + % + \xdef\thischapter{\putwordAppendix{} \appendixletter: + \noexpand\thischaptername}% + \else + \setbox0 = \hbox{#3\enspace}% + \def\toctype{numchap}% + \xdef\thischapter{\putwordChapter{} \the\chapno: + \noexpand\thischaptername}% + \fi\fi\fi + % + % Write the toc entry for this chapter. Must come before the + % \donoderef, because we include the current node name in the toc + % entry, and \donoderef resets it to empty. + \writetocentry{\toctype}{#1}{#3}% + % + % For pdftex, we have to write out the node definition (aka, make + % the pdfdest) after any page break, but before the actual text has + % been typeset. If the destination for the pdf outline is after the + % text, then jumping from the outline may wind up with the text not + % being visible, for instance under high magnification. + \donoderef{#2}% + % + % Typeset the actual heading. + \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \raggedright + \hangindent=\wd0 \centerparametersmaybe + \unhbox0 #1\par}% }% - \bigskip - \penalty5000 + \nobreak\bigskip % no page break after a chapter title + \nobreak } -\def\unnchfplain #1{% -\pchapsepmacro % -{\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000 - \parindent=0pt\raggedright - \rm #1\hfill}}\bigskip \par\penalty 10000 % -} +% @centerchap -- centered and unnumbered. +\let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax +\def\centerchfplain#1{{% + \def\centerparametersmaybe{% + \advance\rightskip by 3\rightskip + \leftskip = \rightskip + \parfillskip = 0pt + }% + \chfplain{#1}{Ynothing}{}% +}} + \CHAPFplain % The default +% I don't think this chapter style is supported any more, so I'm not +% updating it with the new noderef stuff. We'll see. --karl, 11aug03. +% \def\unnchfopen #1{% \chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt\raggedright - \rm #1\hfill}}\bigskip \par\penalty 10000 % + \rm #1\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak } \def\chfopen #1#2{\chapoddpage {\chapfonts @@ -2816,204 +4056,339 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi \par\penalty 5000 % } -\def\CHAPFopen{ -\global\let\chapmacro=\chfopen -\global\let\unnumbchapmacro=\unnchfopen} - -% Parameter controlling skip before section headings. - -% was 17pt plus 8pt minus 4pt -\newskip \subsecheadingskip \subsecheadingskip = 0pt plus 4pt minus 4pt -\def\subsecheadingbreak{\dobreak \subsecheadingskip {-500}} - -% was 21pt plus 8pt minus 4pt -\newskip \secheadingskip \secheadingskip = 0pt plus 4pt minus 4pt -\def\secheadingbreak{\dobreak \secheadingskip {-1000}} - -% @paragraphindent is defined for the Info formatting commands only. -\let\paragraphindent=\comment - -% Section fonts are the base font at magstep2, which produces -% a size a bit more than 14 points in the default situation. - -\def\secheading #1#2#3{\secheadingi {#2.#3\enspace #1}} -\def\plainsecheading #1{\secheadingi {#1}} -\def\secheadingi #1{{\advance \secheadingskip by \parskip % -\secheadingbreak}% -{\secfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000 - \parindent=0pt\raggedright - \rm #1\hfill}}% -\ifdim \parskip<10pt \kern 10pt\kern -\parskip\fi \penalty 10000 } - - -% Subsection fonts are the base font at magstep1, -% which produces a size of 12 points. - -\def\subsecheading #1#2#3#4{\subsecheadingi {#2.#3.#4\enspace #1}} -\def\subsecheadingi #1{{\advance \subsecheadingskip by \parskip % -\subsecheadingbreak}% -{\subsecfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000 - \parindent=0pt\raggedright - \rm #1\hfill}}% -\ifdim \parskip<10pt \kern 10pt\kern -\parskip\fi \penalty 10000 } - -\def\subsubsecfonts{\subsecfonts} % Maybe this should change: - % Perhaps make sssec fonts scaled - % magstep half -\def\subsubsecheading #1#2#3#4#5{\subsubsecheadingi {#2.#3.#4.#5\enspace #1}} -\def\subsubsecheadingi #1{{\advance \subsecheadingskip by \parskip % -\subsecheadingbreak}% -{\subsubsecfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000 - \parindent=0pt\raggedright - \rm #1\hfill}}% -\ifdim \parskip<10pt \kern 10pt\kern -\parskip\fi \penalty 10000} - +\def\centerchfopen #1{% +\chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000 + \parindent=0pt + \hfill {\rm #1}\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak +} + +\def\CHAPFopen{% +\global\let\chapmacro=\chfopen +\global\let\centerchapmacro=\centerchfopen} + + +% Section titles. These macros combine the section number parts and +% call the generic \sectionheading to do the printing. +% +\newskip\secheadingskip +\def\secheadingbreak{\dobreak \secheadingskip{-1000}} + +% Subsection titles. +\newskip\subsecheadingskip +\def\subsecheadingbreak{\dobreak \subsecheadingskip{-500}} + +% Subsubsection titles. +\def\subsubsecheadingskip{\subsecheadingskip} +\def\subsubsecheadingbreak{\subsecheadingbreak} + + +% Print any size, any type, section title. +% +% #1 is the text, #2 is the section level (sec/subsec/subsubsec), #3 is +% the section type for xrefs (Ynumbered, Ynothing, Yappendix), #4 is the +% section number. +% +\def\sectionheading#1#2#3#4{% + {% + % Switch to the right set of fonts. + \csname #2fonts\endcsname \rm + % + % Insert space above the heading. + \csname #2headingbreak\endcsname + % + % Only insert the space after the number if we have a section number. + \def\sectionlevel{#2}% + \def\temptype{#3}% + % + \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword + \setbox0 = \hbox{}% + \def\toctype{unn}% + \gdef\thissection{#1}% + \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword + % for @headings -- no section number, don't include in toc, + % and don't redefine \thissection. + \setbox0 = \hbox{}% + \def\toctype{omit}% + \let\sectionlevel=\empty + \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword + \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}% + \def\toctype{app}% + \gdef\thissection{#1}% + \else + \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}% + \def\toctype{num}% + \gdef\thissection{#1}% + \fi\fi\fi + % + % Write the toc entry (before \donoderef). See comments in \chfplain. + \writetocentry{\toctype\sectionlevel}{#1}{#4}% + % + % Write the node reference (= pdf destination for pdftex). + % Again, see comments in \chfplain. + \donoderef{#3}% + % + % Output the actual section heading. + \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \raggedright + \hangindent=\wd0 % zero if no section number + \unhbox0 #1}% + }% + % Add extra space after the heading -- half of whatever came above it. + % Don't allow stretch, though. + \kern .5 \csname #2headingskip\endcsname + % + % Do not let the kern be a potential breakpoint, as it would be if it + % was followed by glue. + \nobreak + % + % We'll almost certainly start a paragraph next, so don't let that + % glue accumulate. (Not a breakpoint because it's preceded by a + % discardable item.) + \vskip-\parskip + % + % This \nobreak is purely so the last item on the list is a \penalty + % of 10000. This is so other code, for instance \parsebodycommon, can + % check for and avoid allowing breakpoints. Otherwise, it would + % insert a valid breakpoint between: + % @section sec-whatever + % @deffn def-whatever + \nobreak +} + -\message{toc printing,} +\message{toc,} +% Table of contents. +\newwrite\tocfile -% Finish up the main text and prepare to read what we've written -% to \contentsfile. +% Write an entry to the toc file, opening it if necessary. +% Called from @chapter, etc. +% +% Example usage: \writetocentry{sec}{Section Name}{\the\chapno.\the\secno} +% We append the current node name (if any) and page number as additional +% arguments for the \{chap,sec,...}entry macros which will eventually +% read this. The node name is used in the pdf outlines as the +% destination to jump to. +% +% We open the .toc file for writing here instead of at @setfilename (or +% any other fixed time) so that @contents can be anywhere in the document. +% But if #1 is `omit', then we don't do anything. This is used for the +% table of contents chapter openings themselves. +% +\newif\iftocfileopened +\def\omitkeyword{omit}% +% +\def\writetocentry#1#2#3{% + \edef\writetoctype{#1}% + \ifx\writetoctype\omitkeyword \else + \iftocfileopened\else + \immediate\openout\tocfile = \jobname.toc + \global\tocfileopenedtrue + \fi + % + \iflinks + \toks0 = {#2}% + \toks2 = \expandafter{\lastnode}% + \edef\temp{\write\tocfile{\realbackslash #1entry{\the\toks0}{#3}% + {\the\toks2}{\noexpand\folio}}}% + \temp + \fi + \fi + % + % Tell \shipout to create a pdf destination on each page, if we're + % writing pdf. These are used in the table of contents. We can't + % just write one on every page because the title pages are numbered + % 1 and 2 (the page numbers aren't printed), and so are the first + % two pages of the document. Thus, we'd have two destinations named + % `1', and two named `2'. + \ifpdf \global\pdfmakepagedesttrue \fi +} \newskip\contentsrightmargin \contentsrightmargin=1in +\newcount\savepageno +\newcount\lastnegativepageno \lastnegativepageno = -1 + +% Prepare to read what we've written to \tocfile. +% \def\startcontents#1{% - \pagealignmacro - \immediate\closeout \contentsfile - \ifnum \pageno>0 - \pageno = -1 % Request roman numbered pages. - \fi + % If @setchapternewpage on, and @headings double, the contents should + % start on an odd page, unlike chapters. Thus, we maintain + % \contentsalignmacro in parallel with \pagealignmacro. + % From: Torbjorn Granlund + \contentsalignmacro + \immediate\closeout\tocfile + % % Don't need to put `Contents' or `Short Contents' in the headline. % It is abundantly clear what they are. - \unnumbchapmacro{#1}\def\thischapter{}% - \begingroup % Set up to handle contents files properly. + \def\thischapter{}% + \chapmacro{#1}{Yomitfromtoc}{}% + % + \savepageno = \pageno + \begingroup % Set up to handle contents files properly. \catcode`\\=0 \catcode`\{=1 \catcode`\}=2 \catcode`\@=11 - \catcode`\^=7 % to see ^^e4 as \"a etc. juha@piuha.ydi.vtt.fi + % We can't do this, because then an actual ^ in a section + % title fails, e.g., @chapter ^ -- exponentiation. --karl, 9jul97. + %\catcode`\^=7 % to see ^^e4 as \"a etc. juha@piuha.ydi.vtt.fi \raggedbottom % Worry more about breakpoints than the bottom. \advance\hsize by -\contentsrightmargin % Don't use the full line length. + % + % Roman numerals for page numbers. + \ifnum \pageno>0 \global\pageno = \lastnegativepageno \fi } % Normal (long) toc. -\outer\def\contents{% - \startcontents{\putwordTableofContents}% - \input \jobname.toc +\def\contents{% + \startcontents{\putwordTOC}% + \openin 1 \jobname.toc + \ifeof 1 \else + \closein 1 + \input \jobname.toc + \fi + \vfill \eject + \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect + \pdfmakeoutlines \endgroup - \vfill \eject + \lastnegativepageno = \pageno + \global\pageno = \savepageno } % And just the chapters. -\outer\def\summarycontents{% - \startcontents{\putwordShortContents}% +\def\summarycontents{% + \startcontents{\putwordShortTOC}% % - \let\chapentry = \shortchapentry - \let\unnumbchapentry = \shortunnumberedentry + \let\numchapentry = \shortchapentry + \let\appentry = \shortchapentry + \let\unnchapentry = \shortunnchapentry % We want a true roman here for the page numbers. \secfonts - \let\rm=\shortcontrm \let\bf=\shortcontbf \let\sl=\shortcontsl + \let\rm=\shortcontrm \let\bf=\shortcontbf + \let\sl=\shortcontsl \let\tt=\shortconttt \rm + \hyphenpenalty = 10000 \advance\baselineskip by 1pt % Open it up a little. - \def\secentry ##1##2##3##4{} - \def\unnumbsecentry ##1##2{} - \def\subsecentry ##1##2##3##4##5{} - \def\unnumbsubsecentry ##1##2{} - \def\subsubsecentry ##1##2##3##4##5##6{} - \def\unnumbsubsubsecentry ##1##2{} - \input \jobname.toc + \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{} + \let\appsecentry = \numsecentry + \let\unnsecentry = \numsecentry + \let\numsubsecentry = \numsecentry + \let\appsubsecentry = \numsecentry + \let\unnsubsecentry = \numsecentry + \let\numsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry + \let\appsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry + \let\unnsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry + \openin 1 \jobname.toc + \ifeof 1 \else + \closein 1 + \input \jobname.toc + \fi + \vfill \eject + \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect \endgroup - \vfill \eject + \lastnegativepageno = \pageno + \global\pageno = \savepageno } \let\shortcontents = \summarycontents +% Typeset the label for a chapter or appendix for the short contents. +% The arg is, e.g., `A' for an appendix, or `3' for a chapter. +% +\def\shortchaplabel#1{% + % This space should be enough, since a single number is .5em, and the + % widest letter (M) is 1em, at least in the Computer Modern fonts. + % But use \hss just in case. + % (This space doesn't include the extra space that gets added after + % the label; that gets put in by \shortchapentry above.) + % + % We'd like to right-justify chapter numbers, but that looks strange + % with appendix letters. And right-justifying numbers and + % left-justifying letters looks strange when there is less than 10 + % chapters. Have to read the whole toc once to know how many chapters + % there are before deciding ... + \hbox to 1em{#1\hss}% +} + % These macros generate individual entries in the table of contents. % The first argument is the chapter or section name. % The last argument is the page number. % The arguments in between are the chapter number, section number, ... -% Chapter-level things, for both the long and short contents. -\def\chapentry#1#2#3{\dochapentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#3}} - -% See comments in \dochapentry re vbox and related settings -\def\shortchapentry#1#2#3{% - \tocentry{\shortchaplabel{#2}\labelspace #1}{\doshortpageno{#3}}% +% Chapters, in the main contents. +\def\numchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}} +% +% Chapters, in the short toc. +% See comments in \dochapentry re vbox and related settings. +\def\shortchapentry#1#2#3#4{% + \tocentry{\shortchaplabel{#2}\labelspace #1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}% } -% Typeset the label for a chapter or appendix for the short contents. -% The arg is, e.g. `Appendix A' for an appendix, or `3' for a chapter. -% We could simplify the code here by writing out an \appendixentry -% command in the toc file for appendices, instead of using \chapentry -% for both, but it doesn't seem worth it. -\setbox0 = \hbox{\shortcontrm \putwordAppendix } -\newdimen\shortappendixwidth \shortappendixwidth = \wd0 - -\def\shortchaplabel#1{% - % We typeset #1 in a box of constant width, regardless of the text of - % #1, so the chapter titles will come out aligned. - \setbox0 = \hbox{#1}% - \dimen0 = \ifdim\wd0 > \shortappendixwidth \shortappendixwidth \else 0pt \fi - % - % This space should be plenty, since a single number is .5em, and the - % widest letter (M) is 1em, at least in the Computer Modern fonts. - % (This space doesn't include the extra space that gets added after - % the label; that gets put in in \shortchapentry above.) - \advance\dimen0 by 1.1em - \hbox to \dimen0{#1\hfil}% -} +% Appendices, in the main contents. +% Need the word Appendix, and a fixed-size box. +% +\def\appendixbox#1{% + % We use M since it's probably the widest letter. + \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} M}% + \hbox to \wd0{\putwordAppendix{} #1\hss}} +% +\def\appentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{\appendixbox{#2}\labelspace#1}{#4}} -\def\unnumbchapentry#1#2{\dochapentry{#1}{#2}} -\def\shortunnumberedentry#1#2{\tocentry{#1}{\doshortpageno{#2}}} +% Unnumbered chapters. +\def\unnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#1}{#4}} +\def\shortunnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\tocentry{#1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}} % Sections. -\def\secentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#2.#3\labelspace#1}{#4}} -\def\unnumbsecentry#1#2{\dosecentry{#1}{#2}} +\def\numsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}} +\let\appsecentry=\numsecentry +\def\unnsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#1}{#4}} % Subsections. -\def\subsecentry#1#2#3#4#5{\dosubsecentry{#2.#3.#4\labelspace#1}{#5}} -\def\unnumbsubsecentry#1#2{\dosubsecentry{#1}{#2}} +\def\numsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}} +\let\appsubsecentry=\numsubsecentry +\def\unnsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#1}{#4}} % And subsubsections. -\def\subsubsecentry#1#2#3#4#5#6{% - \dosubsubsecentry{#2.#3.#4.#5\labelspace#1}{#6}} -\def\unnumbsubsubsecentry#1#2{\dosubsubsecentry{#1}{#2}} - +\def\numsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}} +\let\appsubsubsecentry=\numsubsubsecentry +\def\unnsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#1}{#4}} % This parameter controls the indentation of the various levels. -\newdimen\tocindent \tocindent = 3pc +\newdimen\tocindent \tocindent = 2pc % Now for the actual typesetting. In all these, #1 is the text and #2 is the % page number. % -% If the toc has to be broken over pages, we would want to be at chapters +% If the toc has to be broken over pages, we want it to be at chapters % if at all possible; hence the \penalty. \def\dochapentry#1#2{% - \penalty-300 \vskip\baselineskip + \penalty-300 \vskip1\baselineskip plus.33\baselineskip minus.25\baselineskip \begingroup \chapentryfonts - \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno{#2}}% + \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% \endgroup - \nobreak\vskip .25\baselineskip + \nobreak\vskip .25\baselineskip plus.1\baselineskip } \def\dosecentry#1#2{\begingroup \secentryfonts \leftskip=\tocindent - \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno{#2}}% + \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% \endgroup} \def\dosubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup \subsecentryfonts \leftskip=2\tocindent - \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno{#2}}% + \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% \endgroup} \def\dosubsubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup \subsubsecentryfonts \leftskip=3\tocindent - \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno{#2}}% + \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% \endgroup} % Final typesetting of a toc entry; we use the same \entry macro as for % the index entries, but we want to suppress hyphenation here. (We % can't do that in the \entry macro, since index entries might consist % of hyphenated-identifiers-that-do-not-fit-on-a-line-and-nothing-else.) -% \def\tocentry#1#2{\begingroup - \hyphenpenalty = 10000 + \vskip 0pt plus1pt % allow a little stretch for the sake of nice page breaks + % Do not use \turnoffactive in these arguments. Since the toc is + % typeset in cmr, characters such as _ would come out wrong; we + % have to do the usual translation tricks. \entry{#1}{#2}% \endgroup} @@ -3025,45 +4400,34 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi \def\chapentryfonts{\secfonts \rm} \def\secentryfonts{\textfonts} -\let\subsecentryfonts = \textfonts -\let\subsubsecentryfonts = \textfonts +\def\subsecentryfonts{\textfonts} +\def\subsubsecentryfonts{\textfonts} \message{environments,} +% @foo ... @end foo. +% @point{}, @result{}, @expansion{}, @print{}, @equiv{}. +% % Since these characters are used in examples, it should be an even number of % \tt widths. Each \tt character is 1en, so two makes it 1em. -% Furthermore, these definitions must come after we define our fonts. -\newbox\dblarrowbox \newbox\longdblarrowbox -\newbox\pushcharbox \newbox\bullbox -\newbox\equivbox \newbox\errorbox - -\let\ptexequiv = \equiv - -%{\tentt -%\global\setbox\dblarrowbox = \hbox to 1em{\hfil$\Rightarrow$\hfil} -%\global\setbox\longdblarrowbox = \hbox to 1em{\hfil$\mapsto$\hfil} -%\global\setbox\pushcharbox = \hbox to 1em{\hfil$\dashv$\hfil} -%\global\setbox\equivbox = \hbox to 1em{\hfil$\ptexequiv$\hfil} -% Adapted from the manmac format (p.420 of TeXbook) -%\global\setbox\bullbox = \hbox to 1em{\kern.15em\vrule height .75ex width .85ex -% depth .1ex\hfil} -%} - +% \def\point{$\star$} - \def\result{\leavevmode\raise.15ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\Rightarrow$\hfil}} \def\expansion{\leavevmode\raise.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\mapsto$\hfil}} \def\print{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\dashv$\hfil}} - \def\equiv{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\ptexequiv$\hfil}} +% The @error{} command. % Adapted from the TeXbook's \boxit. +% +\newbox\errorbox +% {\tentt \global\dimen0 = 3em}% Width of the box. \dimen2 = .55pt % Thickness of rules % The text. (`r' is open on the right, `e' somewhat less so on the left.) \setbox0 = \hbox{\kern-.75pt \tensf error\kern-1.5pt} - +% \global\setbox\errorbox=\hbox to \dimen0{\hfil \hsize = \dimen0 \advance\hsize by -5.8pt % Space to left+right. \advance\hsize by -2\dimen2 % Rules. @@ -3074,8 +4438,7 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi \kern3pt\vrule width\dimen2}% Space to right. \hrule height\dimen2} \hfil} - -% The @error{} command. +% \def\error{\leavevmode\lower.7ex\copy\errorbox} % @tex ... @end tex escapes into raw Tex temporarily. @@ -3083,34 +4446,44 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi % But \@ or @@ will get a plain tex @ character. \def\tex{\begingroup -\catcode `\\=0 \catcode `\{=1 \catcode `\}=2 -\catcode `\$=3 \catcode `\&=4 \catcode `\#=6 -\catcode `\^=7 \catcode `\_=8 \catcode `\~=13 \let~=\tie -\catcode `\%=14 -\catcode 43=12 -\catcode`\"=12 -\catcode`\==12 -\catcode`\|=12 -\catcode`\<=12 -\catcode`\>=12 -\escapechar=`\\ -% -\let\~=\ptextilde -\let\{=\ptexlbrace -\let\}=\ptexrbrace -\let\.=\ptexdot -\let\*=\ptexstar -\let\dots=\ptexdots -\def\@{@}% -\let\bullet=\ptexbullet -\let\b=\ptexb \let\c=\ptexc \let\i=\ptexi \let\t=\ptext \let\l=\ptexl -\let\L=\ptexL -% + \catcode `\\=0 \catcode `\{=1 \catcode `\}=2 + \catcode `\$=3 \catcode `\&=4 \catcode `\#=6 + \catcode `\^=7 \catcode `\_=8 \catcode `\~=\active \let~=\tie + \catcode `\%=14 + \catcode `\+=\other + \catcode `\"=\other + \catcode `\==\other + \catcode `\|=\other + \catcode `\<=\other + \catcode `\>=\other + \escapechar=`\\ + % + \let\b=\ptexb + \let\bullet=\ptexbullet + \let\c=\ptexc + \let\,=\ptexcomma + \let\.=\ptexdot + \let\dots=\ptexdots + \let\equiv=\ptexequiv + \let\!=\ptexexclam + \let\i=\ptexi + \let\indent=\ptexindent + \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent + \let\{=\ptexlbrace + \let\+=\tabalign + \let\}=\ptexrbrace + \let\/=\ptexslash + \let\*=\ptexstar + \let\t=\ptext + % + \def\endldots{\mathinner{\ldots\ldots\ldots\ldots}}% + \def\enddots{\relax\ifmmode\endldots\else$\mathsurround=0pt \endldots\,$\fi}% + \def\@{@}% \let\Etex=\endgroup} -% Define @lisp ... @endlisp. +% Define @lisp ... @end lisp. % @lisp does a \begingroup so it can rebind things, -% including the definition of @endlisp (which normally is erroneous). +% including the definition of @end lisp (which normally is erroneous). % Amount to narrow the margins by for @lisp. \newskip\lispnarrowing \lispnarrowing=0.4in @@ -3139,19 +4512,30 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi % Make spacing and below environment symmetrical. We use \parskip here % to help in doing that, since in @example-like environments \parskip % is reset to zero; thus the \afterenvbreak inserts no space -- but the -% start of the next paragraph will insert \parskip +% start of the next paragraph will insert \parskip. % -\def\aboveenvbreak{{\advance\envskipamount by \parskip -\endgraf \ifdim\lastskip<\envskipamount -\removelastskip \penalty-50 \vskip\envskipamount \fi}} +\def\aboveenvbreak{{% + % =10000 instead of <10000 because of a special case in \itemzzz, q.v. + \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else + \advance\envskipamount by \parskip + \endgraf + \ifdim\lastskip<\envskipamount + \removelastskip + % it's not a good place to break if the last penalty was \nobreak + % or better ... + \ifnum\lastpenalty>10000 \else \penalty-50 \fi + \vskip\envskipamount + \fi + \fi +}} \let\afterenvbreak = \aboveenvbreak % \nonarrowing is a flag. If "set", @lisp etc don't narrow margins. \let\nonarrowing=\relax -%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% -% \cartouche: draw rectangle w/rounded corners around argument +% @cartouche ... @end cartouche: draw rectangle w/rounded corners around +% environment contents. \font\circle=lcircle10 \newdimen\circthick \newdimen\cartouter\newdimen\cartinner @@ -3163,50 +4547,51 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi \def\cbl{{\circle\char'012\hskip -6pt}} \def\cbr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'011}} \def\carttop{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip - \ctl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\ctr - \hskip\rskip}} + \ctl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\ctr + \hskip\rskip}} \def\cartbot{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip - \cbl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\cbr - \hskip\rskip}} + \cbl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\cbr + \hskip\rskip}} % \newskip\lskip\newskip\rskip -\long\def\cartouche{% +\def\cartouche{% +\par % can't be in the midst of a paragraph. \begingroup - \lskip=\leftskip \rskip=\rightskip - \leftskip=0pt\rightskip=0pt %we want these *outside*. - \cartinner=\hsize \advance\cartinner by-\lskip - \advance\cartinner by-\rskip - \cartouter=\hsize - \advance\cartouter by 18pt % allow for 3pt kerns on either -% side, and for 6pt waste from -% each corner char - \normbskip=\baselineskip \normpskip=\parskip \normlskip=\lineskip - % Flag to tell @lisp, etc., not to narrow margin. - \let\nonarrowing=\comment - \vbox\bgroup - \baselineskip=0pt\parskip=0pt\lineskip=0pt - \carttop - \hbox\bgroup - \hskip\lskip - \vrule\kern3pt - \vbox\bgroup - \hsize=\cartinner - \kern3pt - \begingroup - \baselineskip=\normbskip - \lineskip=\normlskip - \parskip=\normpskip - \vskip -\parskip + \lskip=\leftskip \rskip=\rightskip + \leftskip=0pt\rightskip=0pt %we want these *outside*. + \cartinner=\hsize \advance\cartinner by-\lskip + \advance\cartinner by-\rskip + \cartouter=\hsize + \advance\cartouter by 18.4pt % allow for 3pt kerns on either +% side, and for 6pt waste from +% each corner char, and rule thickness + \normbskip=\baselineskip \normpskip=\parskip \normlskip=\lineskip + % Flag to tell @lisp, etc., not to narrow margin. + \let\nonarrowing=\comment + \vbox\bgroup + \baselineskip=0pt\parskip=0pt\lineskip=0pt + \carttop + \hbox\bgroup + \hskip\lskip + \vrule\kern3pt + \vbox\bgroup + \hsize=\cartinner + \kern3pt + \begingroup + \baselineskip=\normbskip + \lineskip=\normlskip + \parskip=\normpskip + \vskip -\parskip \def\Ecartouche{% - \endgroup - \kern3pt - \egroup - \kern3pt\vrule - \hskip\rskip - \egroup - \cartbot - \egroup + \endgroup + \kern3pt + \egroup + \kern3pt\vrule + \hskip\rskip + \egroup + \cartbot + \egroup \endgroup }} @@ -3218,7 +4603,6 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi \inENV % This group ends at the end of the body \hfuzz = 12pt % Don't be fussy \sepspaces % Make spaces be word-separators rather than space tokens. - \singlespace \let\par = \lisppar % don't ignore blank lines \obeylines % each line of input is a line of output \parskip = 0pt @@ -3234,57 +4618,57 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi \fi } -% To ending an @example-like environment, we first end the paragraph -% (via \afterenvbreak's vertical glue), and then the group. That way we -% keep the zero \parskip that the environments set -- \parskip glue -% will be inserted at the beginning of the next paragraph in the -% document, after the environment. +% Define the \E... control sequence only if we are inside the particular +% environment, so the error checking in \end will work. +% +% To end an @example-like environment, we first end the paragraph (via +% \afterenvbreak's vertical glue), and then the group. That way we keep +% the zero \parskip that the environments set -- \parskip glue will be +% inserted at the beginning of the next paragraph in the document, after +% the environment. % -\def\nonfillfinish{\afterenvbreak\endgroup}% +\def\nonfillfinish{\afterenvbreak\endgroup} -% This macro is +% @lisp: indented, narrowed, typewriter font. \def\lisp{\begingroup \nonfillstart \let\Elisp = \nonfillfinish \tt - \rawbackslash % have \ input char produce \ char from current font - \gobble + \let\kbdfont = \kbdexamplefont % Allow @kbd to do something special. + \gobble % eat return } -% Define the \E... control sequence only if we are inside the -% environment, so the error checking in \end will work. -% -% We must call \lisp last in the definition, since it reads the -% return following the @example (or whatever) command. -% +% @example: Same as @lisp. \def\example{\begingroup \def\Eexample{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}\lisp} -\def\smallexample{\begingroup \def\Esmallexample{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}\lisp} -\def\smalllisp{\begingroup \def\Esmalllisp{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}\lisp} -% @smallexample and @smalllisp. This is not used unless the @smallbook -% command is given. Originally contributed by Pavel@xerox. -% -\def\smalllispx{\begingroup - \nonfillstart - \let\Esmalllisp = \nonfillfinish - \let\Esmallexample = \nonfillfinish - % - % Smaller interline space and fonts for small examples. - \setleading{10pt}% - \indexfonts \tt - \rawbackslash % make \ output the \ character from the current font (tt) - \gobble +% @smallexample and @smalllisp: use smaller fonts. +% Originally contributed by Pavel@xerox. +\def\smalllisp{\begingroup + \def\Esmalllisp{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}% + \def\Esmallexample{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}% + \smallexamplefonts + \lisp } +\let\smallexample = \smalllisp -% This is @display; same as @lisp except use roman font. + +% @display: same as @lisp except keep current font. % \def\display{\begingroup \nonfillstart \let\Edisplay = \nonfillfinish \gobble } +% +% @smalldisplay: @display plus smaller fonts. +% +\def\smalldisplay{\begingroup + \def\Esmalldisplay{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}% + \smallexamplefonts \rm + \display +} -% This is @format; same as @display except don't narrow margins. +% @format: same as @display except don't narrow margins. % \def\format{\begingroup \let\nonarrowing = t @@ -3292,21 +4676,29 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi \let\Eformat = \nonfillfinish \gobble } - -% @flushleft (same as @format) and @flushright. % -\def\flushleft{\begingroup - \let\nonarrowing = t - \nonfillstart - \let\Eflushleft = \nonfillfinish - \gobble +% @smallformat: @format plus smaller fonts. +% +\def\smallformat{\begingroup + \def\Esmallformat{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}% + \smallexamplefonts \rm + \format } + +% @flushleft (same as @format). +% +\def\flushleft{\begingroup \def\Eflushleft{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}\format} + +% @flushright. +% \def\flushright{\begingroup \let\nonarrowing = t \nonfillstart \let\Eflushright = \nonfillfinish \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fill - \gobble} + \gobble +} + % @quotation does normal linebreaking (hence we can't use \nonfillstart) % and narrows the margins. @@ -3314,7 +4706,6 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi \def\quotation{% \begingroup\inENV %This group ends at the end of the @quotation body {\parskip=0pt \aboveenvbreak}% because \aboveenvbreak inserts \parskip - \singlespace \parindent=0pt % We have retained a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're % doing normal filling. So to avoid extra space below the environment... @@ -3329,22 +4720,255 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi \fi } + +% LaTeX-like @verbatim...@end verbatim and @verb{...} +% If we want to allow any as delimiter, +% we need the curly braces so that makeinfo sees the @verb command, eg: +% `@verbx...x' would look like the '@verbx' command. --janneke@gnu.org +% +% [Knuth]: Donald Ervin Knuth, 1996. The TeXbook. +% +% [Knuth] p.344; only we need to do the other characters Texinfo sets +% active too. Otherwise, they get lost as the first character on a +% verbatim line. +\def\dospecials{% + \do\ \do\\\do\{\do\}\do\$\do\&% + \do\#\do\^\do\^^K\do\_\do\^^A\do\%\do\~% + \do\<\do\>\do\|\do\@\do+\do\"% +} +% +% [Knuth] p. 380 +\def\uncatcodespecials{% + \def\do##1{\catcode`##1=12}\dospecials} +% +% [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391 +% Disable Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font +\begingroup + \catcode`\`=\active\gdef`{\relax\lq} +\endgroup +% +% Setup for the @verb command. +% +% Eight spaces for a tab +\begingroup + \catcode`\^^I=\active + \gdef\tabeightspaces{\catcode`\^^I=\active\def^^I{\ \ \ \ \ \ \ \ }} +\endgroup +% +\def\setupverb{% + \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim + \def\par{\leavevmode\endgraf}% + \catcode`\`=\active + \tabeightspaces + % Respect line breaks, + % print special symbols as themselves, and + % make each space count + % must do in this order: + \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces +} + +% Setup for the @verbatim environment +% +% Real tab expansion +\newdimen\tabw \setbox0=\hbox{\tt\space} \tabw=8\wd0 % tab amount +% +\def\starttabbox{\setbox0=\hbox\bgroup} +\begingroup + \catcode`\^^I=\active + \gdef\tabexpand{% + \catcode`\^^I=\active + \def^^I{\leavevmode\egroup + \dimen0=\wd0 % the width so far, or since the previous tab + \divide\dimen0 by\tabw + \multiply\dimen0 by\tabw % compute previous multiple of \tabw + \advance\dimen0 by\tabw % advance to next multiple of \tabw + \wd0=\dimen0 \box0 \starttabbox + }% + } +\endgroup +\def\setupverbatim{% + % Easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim + \tt + \def\par{\leavevmode\egroup\box0\endgraf}% + \catcode`\`=\active + \tabexpand + % Respect line breaks, + % print special symbols as themselves, and + % make each space count + % must do in this order: + \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces + \everypar{\starttabbox}% +} + +% Do the @verb magic: verbatim text is quoted by unique +% delimiter characters. Before first delimiter expect a +% right brace, after last delimiter expect closing brace: +% +% \def\doverb'{'#1'}'{#1} +% +% [Knuth] p. 382; only eat outer {} +\begingroup + \catcode`[=1\catcode`]=2\catcode`\{=12\catcode`\}=12 + \gdef\doverb{#1[\def\next##1#1}[##1\endgroup]\next] +\endgroup +% +\def\verb{\begingroup\setupverb\doverb} +% +% +% Do the @verbatim magic: define the macro \doverbatim so that +% the (first) argument ends when '@end verbatim' is reached, ie: +% +% \def\doverbatim#1@end verbatim{#1} +% +% For Texinfo it's a lot easier than for LaTeX, +% because texinfo's \verbatim doesn't stop at '\end{verbatim}': +% we need not redefine '\', '{' and '}'. +% +% Inspired by LaTeX's verbatim command set [latex.ltx] +%% Include LaTeX hack for completeness -- never know +%% \begingroup +%% \catcode`|=0 \catcode`[=1 +%% \catcode`]=2\catcode`\{=12\catcode`\}=12\catcode`\ =\active +%% \catcode`\\=12|gdef|doverbatim#1@end verbatim[ +%% #1|endgroup|def|Everbatim[]|end[verbatim]] +%% |endgroup +% +\begingroup + \catcode`\ =\active + \obeylines % + % ignore everything up to the first ^^M, that's the newline at the end + % of the @verbatim input line itself. Otherwise we get an extra blank + % line in the output. + \gdef\doverbatim#1^^M#2@end verbatim{#2\end{verbatim}}% +\endgroup +% +\def\verbatim{% + \def\Everbatim{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}% + \begingroup + \nonfillstart + \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent + \begingroup\setupverbatim\doverbatim +} + +% @verbatiminclude FILE - insert text of file in verbatim environment. +% +% Allow normal characters that we make active in the argument (a file name). +\def\verbatiminclude{% + \begingroup + \catcode`\\=\other + \catcode`~=\other + \catcode`^=\other + \catcode`_=\other + \catcode`|=\other + \catcode`<=\other + \catcode`>=\other + \catcode`+=\other + \parsearg\doverbatiminclude +} +\def\setupverbatiminclude{% + \begingroup + \nonfillstart + \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent + \begingroup\setupverbatim +} +% +\def\doverbatiminclude#1{% + % Restore active chars for included file. + \endgroup + \begingroup + \let\value=\expandablevalue + \def\thisfile{#1}% + \expandafter\expandafter\setupverbatiminclude\input\thisfile + \endgroup + \nonfillfinish + \endgroup +} + +% @copying ... @end copying. +% Save the text away for @insertcopying later. Many commands won't be +% allowed in this context, but that's ok. +% +% We save the uninterpreted tokens, rather than creating a box. +% Saving the text in a box would be much easier, but then all the +% typesetting commands (@smallbook, font changes, etc.) have to be done +% beforehand -- and a) we want @copying to be done first in the source +% file; b) letting users define the frontmatter in as flexible order as +% possible is very desirable. +% +\def\copying{\begingroup + % Define a command to swallow text until we reach `@end copying'. + % \ is the escape char in this texinfo.tex file, so it is the + % delimiter for the command; @ will be the escape char when we read + % it, but that doesn't matter. + \long\def\docopying##1\end copying{\gdef\copyingtext{##1}\enddocopying}% + % + % We must preserve ^^M's in the input file; see \insertcopying below. + \catcode`\^^M = \active + \docopying +} + +% What we do to finish off the copying text. +% +\def\enddocopying{\endgroup\ignorespaces} + +% @insertcopying. Here we must play games with ^^M's. On the one hand, +% we need them to delimit commands such as `@end quotation', so they +% must be active. On the other hand, we certainly don't want every +% end-of-line to be a \par, as would happen with the normal active +% definition of ^^M. On the third hand, two ^^M's in a row should still +% generate a \par. +% +% Our approach is to make ^^M insert a space and a penalty1 normally; +% then it can also check if \lastpenalty=1. If it does, then manually +% do \par. +% +% This messes up the normal definitions of @c[omment], so we redefine +% it. Similarly for @ignore. (These commands are used in the gcc +% manual for man page generation.) +% +% Seems pretty fragile, most line-oriented commands will presumably +% fail, but for the limited use of getting the copying text (which +% should be quite simple) inserted, we can hope it's ok. +% +{\catcode`\^^M=\active % +\gdef\insertcopying{\begingroup % + \parindent = 0pt % looks wrong on title page + \def^^M{% + \ifnum \lastpenalty=1 % + \par % + \else % + \space \penalty 1 % + \fi % + }% + % + % Fix @c[omment] for catcode 13 ^^M's. + \def\c##1^^M{\ignorespaces}% + \let\comment = \c % + % + % Don't bother jumping through all the hoops that \doignore does, it + % would be very hard since the catcodes are already set. + \long\def\ignore##1\end ignore{\ignorespaces}% + % + \copyingtext % +\endgroup}% +} + \message{defuns,} -% Define formatter for defuns -% First, allow user to change definition object font (\df) internally -\def\setdeffont #1 {\csname DEF#1\endcsname} +% @defun etc. \newskip\defbodyindent \defbodyindent=.4in \newskip\defargsindent \defargsindent=50pt -\newskip\deftypemargin \deftypemargin=12pt \newskip\deflastargmargin \deflastargmargin=18pt \newcount\parencount -% define \functionparens, which makes ( and ) and & do special things. -% \functionparens affects the group it is contained in. + +% We want ()&[] to print specially on the defun line. +% \def\activeparens{% -\catcode`\(=\active \catcode`\)=\active \catcode`\&=\active -\catcode`\[=\active \catcode`\]=\active} + \catcode`\(=\active \catcode`\)=\active + \catcode`\&=\active + \catcode`\[=\active \catcode`\]=\active +} % Make control sequences which act like normal parenthesis chars. \let\lparen = ( \let\rparen = ) @@ -3365,16 +4989,17 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi % Definitions of (, ) and & used in args for functions. % This is the definition of ( outside of all parentheses. -\gdef\oprm#1 {{\rm\char`\(}#1 \bf \let(=\opnested % -\global\advance\parencount by 1 } +\gdef\oprm#1 {{\rm\char`\(}#1 \bf \let(=\opnested + \global\advance\parencount by 1 +} % % This is the definition of ( when already inside a level of parens. \gdef\opnested{\char`\(\global\advance\parencount by 1 } % \gdef\clrm{% Print a paren in roman if it is taking us back to depth of 0. -% also in that case restore the outer-level definition of (. -\ifnum \parencount=1 {\rm \char `\)}\sl \let(=\oprm \else \char `\) \fi -\global\advance \parencount by -1 } + % also in that case restore the outer-level definition of (. + \ifnum \parencount=1 {\rm \char `\)}\sl \let(=\oprm \else \char `\) \fi + \global\advance \parencount by -1 } % If we encounter &foo, then turn on ()-hacking afterwards \gdef\amprm#1 {{\rm\}\let(=\oprm \let)=\clrm\ } % @@ -3382,116 +5007,187 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi } % End of definition inside \activeparens %% These parens (in \boldbrax) actually are a little bolder than the %% contained text. This is especially needed for [ and ] -\def\opnr{{\sf\char`\(}} \def\clnr{{\sf\char`\)}} \def\ampnr{\&} -\def\lbrb{{\bf\char`\[}} \def\rbrb{{\bf\char`\]}} - -% First, defname, which formats the header line itself. -% #1 should be the function name. -% #2 should be the type of definition, such as "Function". - -\def\defname #1#2{% -% Get the values of \leftskip and \rightskip as they were -% outside the @def... -\dimen2=\leftskip -\advance\dimen2 by -\defbodyindent -\dimen3=\rightskip -\advance\dimen3 by -\defbodyindent -\noindent % -\setbox0=\hbox{\hskip \deflastargmargin{\rm #2}\hskip \deftypemargin}% -\dimen0=\hsize \advance \dimen0 by -\wd0 % compute size for first line -\dimen1=\hsize \advance \dimen1 by -\defargsindent %size for continuations -\parshape 2 0in \dimen0 \defargsindent \dimen1 % -% Now output arg 2 ("Function" or some such) -% ending at \deftypemargin from the right margin, -% but stuck inside a box of width 0 so it does not interfere with linebreaking -{% Adjust \hsize to exclude the ambient margins, -% so that \rightline will obey them. -\advance \hsize by -\dimen2 \advance \hsize by -\dimen3 -\rlap{\rightline{{\rm #2}\hskip \deftypemargin}}}% -% Make all lines underfull and no complaints: -\tolerance=10000 \hbadness=10000 -\advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent -\exdentamount=\defbodyindent -{\df #1}\enskip % Generate function name -} - -% Actually process the body of a definition -% #1 should be the terminating control sequence, such as \Edefun. -% #2 should be the "another name" control sequence, such as \defunx. -% #3 should be the control sequence that actually processes the header, -% such as \defunheader. - -\def\defparsebody #1#2#3{\begingroup\inENV% Environment for definitionbody -\medbreak % -% Define the end token that this defining construct specifies -% so that it will exit this group. -\def#1{\endgraf\endgroup\medbreak}% -\def#2{\begingroup\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit#3}% -\parindent=0in -\advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent \advance \rightskip by \defbodyindent -\exdentamount=\defbodyindent -\begingroup % -\catcode 61=\active % 61 is `=' -\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit#3} - -\def\defmethparsebody #1#2#3#4 {\begingroup\inENV % -\medbreak % -% Define the end token that this defining construct specifies -% so that it will exit this group. -\def#1{\endgraf\endgroup\medbreak}% -\def#2##1 {\begingroup\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit{#3{##1}}}% -\parindent=0in -\advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent \advance \rightskip by \defbodyindent -\exdentamount=\defbodyindent -\begingroup\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit{#3{#4}}} - -\def\defopparsebody #1#2#3#4#5 {\begingroup\inENV % -\medbreak % -% Define the end token that this defining construct specifies -% so that it will exit this group. -\def#1{\endgraf\endgroup\medbreak}% -\def#2##1 ##2 {\def#4{##1}% -\begingroup\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit{#3{##2}}}% -\parindent=0in -\advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent \advance \rightskip by \defbodyindent -\exdentamount=\defbodyindent -\begingroup\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit{#3{#5}}} +\def\opnr{{\sf\char`\(}\global\advance\parencount by 1 } +\def\clnr{{\sf\char`\)}\global\advance\parencount by -1 } +\let\ampnr = \& +\def\lbrb{{\bf\char`\[}} +\def\rbrb{{\bf\char`\]}} -% These parsing functions are similar to the preceding ones -% except that they do not make parens into active characters. -% These are used for "variables" since they have no arguments. +% Active &'s sneak into the index arguments, so make sure it's defined. +{ + \catcode`& = \active + \global\let& = \ampnr +} -\def\defvarparsebody #1#2#3{\begingroup\inENV% Environment for definitionbody -\medbreak % -% Define the end token that this defining construct specifies -% so that it will exit this group. -\def#1{\endgraf\endgroup\medbreak}% -\def#2{\begingroup\obeylines\spacesplit#3}% -\parindent=0in -\advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent \advance \rightskip by \defbodyindent -\exdentamount=\defbodyindent -\begingroup % -\catcode 61=\active % -\obeylines\spacesplit#3} +% \defname, which formats the name of the @def (not the args). +% #1 is the function name. +% #2 is the type of definition, such as "Function". +% +\def\defname#1#2{% + % How we'll output the type name. Putting it in brackets helps + % distinguish it from the body text that may end up on the next line + % just below it. + \ifempty{#2}% + \def\defnametype{}% + \else + \def\defnametype{[\rm #2]}% + \fi + % + % Get the values of \leftskip and \rightskip as they were outside the @def... + \dimen2=\leftskip + \advance\dimen2 by -\defbodyindent + % + % Figure out values for the paragraph shape. + \setbox0=\hbox{\hskip \deflastargmargin{\defnametype}}% + \dimen0=\hsize \advance \dimen0 by -\wd0 % compute size for first line + \dimen1=\hsize \advance \dimen1 by -\defargsindent % size for continuations + \parshape 2 0in \dimen0 \defargsindent \dimen1 + % + % Output arg 2 ("Function" or some such) but stuck inside a box of + % width 0 so it does not interfere with linebreaking. + \noindent + % + {% Adjust \hsize to exclude the ambient margins, + % so that \rightline will obey them. + \advance \hsize by -\dimen2 + \dimen3 = 0pt % was -1.25pc + \rlap{\rightline{\defnametype\kern\dimen3}}% + }% + % + % Allow all lines to be underfull without complaint: + \tolerance=10000 \hbadness=10000 + \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent + \exdentamount=\defbodyindent + {\df #1}\enskip % output function name + % \defunargs will be called next to output the arguments, if any. +} -% This is used for \def{tp,vr}parsebody. It could probably be used for -% some of the others, too, with some judicious conditionals. -% +% Common pieces to start any @def... +% #1 is the \E... control sequence to end the definition (which we define). +% #2 is the \...x control sequence (which our caller defines). +% #3 is the control sequence to process the header, such as \defunheader. +% \def\parsebodycommon#1#2#3{% - \begingroup\inENV % - \medbreak % - % Define the end token that this defining construct specifies + \begingroup\inENV + % If there are two @def commands in a row, we'll have a \nobreak, + % which is there to keep the function description together with its + % header. But if there's nothing but headers, we need to allow a + % break somewhere. Check for penalty 10002 (inserted by + % \defargscommonending) instead of 10000, since the sectioning + % commands insert a \penalty10000, and we don't want to allow a break + % between a section heading and a defun. + \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty2000 \fi + % + % Similarly, after a section heading, do not allow a break. + % But do insert the glue. + \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \medbreak + \else \medskip % preceded by discardable penalty, so not a breakpoint + \fi + % + % Define the \E... end token that this defining construct specifies % so that it will exit this group. \def#1{\endgraf\endgroup\medbreak}% - \def#2##1 {\begingroup\obeylines\spacesplit{#3{##1}}}% + % \parindent=0in - \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent \advance \rightskip by \defbodyindent + \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent \exdentamount=\defbodyindent +} + +% Common part of the \...x definitions. +% +\def\defxbodycommon{% + % As with \parsebodycommon above, allow line break if we have multiple + % x headers in a row. It's not a great place, though. + \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty2000 \fi + % + \begingroup\obeylines +} + +% Process body of @defun, @deffn, @defmac, etc. +% +\def\defparsebody#1#2#3{% + \parsebodycommon{#1}{#2}{#3}% + \def#2{\defxbodycommon \activeparens \spacesplit#3}% + \catcode\equalChar=\active + \begingroup\obeylines\activeparens + \spacesplit#3% +} + +% #1, #2, #3 are the common arguments (see \parsebodycommon above). +% #4, delimited by the space, is the class name. +% +\def\defmethparsebody#1#2#3#4 {% + \parsebodycommon{#1}{#2}{#3}% + \def#2##1 {\defxbodycommon \activeparens \spacesplit{#3{##1}}}% + \begingroup\obeylines\activeparens + % The \empty here prevents misinterpretation of a construct such as + % @deffn {whatever} {Enharmonic comma} + % See comments at \deftpparsebody, although in our case we don't have + % to remove the \empty afterwards, since it is empty. + \spacesplit{#3{#4}}\empty +} + +% Used for @deftypemethod and @deftypeivar. +% #1, #2, #3 are the common arguments (see \defparsebody). +% #4, delimited by a space, is the class name. +% #5 is the method's return type. +% +\def\deftypemethparsebody#1#2#3#4 #5 {% + \parsebodycommon{#1}{#2}{#3}% + \def#2##1 ##2 {\defxbodycommon \activeparens \spacesplit{#3{##1}{##2}}}% + \begingroup\obeylines\activeparens + \spacesplit{#3{#4}{#5}}% +} + +% Used for @deftypeop. The change from \deftypemethparsebody is an +% extra argument at the beginning which is the `category', instead of it +% being the hardwired string `Method' or `Instance Variable'. We have +% to account for this both in the \...x definition and in parsing the +% input at hand. Thus also need a control sequence (passed as #5) for +% the \E... definition to assign the category name to. +% +\def\deftypeopparsebody#1#2#3#4#5 #6 {% + \parsebodycommon{#1}{#2}{#3}% + \def#2##1 ##2 ##3 {\def#4{##1}% + \defxbodycommon \activeparens \spacesplit{#3{##2}{##3}}}% + \begingroup\obeylines\activeparens + \spacesplit{#3{#5}{#6}}% +} + +% For @defop. +\def\defopparsebody #1#2#3#4#5 {% + \parsebodycommon{#1}{#2}{#3}% + \def#2##1 ##2 {\def#4{##1}% + \defxbodycommon \activeparens \spacesplit{#3{##2}}}% + \begingroup\obeylines\activeparens + \spacesplit{#3{#5}}% +} + +% These parsing functions are similar to the preceding ones +% except that they do not make parens into active characters. +% These are used for "variables" since they have no arguments. +% +\def\defvarparsebody #1#2#3{% + \parsebodycommon{#1}{#2}{#3}% + \def#2{\defxbodycommon \spacesplit#3}% + \catcode\equalChar=\active + \begingroup\obeylines + \spacesplit#3% +} + +% @defopvar. +\def\defopvarparsebody #1#2#3#4#5 {% + \parsebodycommon{#1}{#2}{#3}% + \def#2##1 ##2 {\def#4{##1}% + \defxbodycommon \spacesplit{#3{##2}}}% \begingroup\obeylines + \spacesplit{#3{#5}}% } \def\defvrparsebody#1#2#3#4 {% \parsebodycommon{#1}{#2}{#3}% + \def#2##1 {\defxbodycommon \spacesplit{#3{##1}}}% + \begingroup\obeylines \spacesplit{#3{#4}}% } @@ -3506,65 +5202,64 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi % \def\deftpparsebody #1#2#3#4 {% \parsebodycommon{#1}{#2}{#3}% + \def#2##1 {\defxbodycommon \spacesplit{#3{##1}}}% + \begingroup\obeylines \spacesplit{\parsetpheaderline{#3{#4}}}\empty } % Fine, but then we have to eventually remove the \empty *and* the -% braces (if any). That's what this does, putting the result in \tptemp. -% -\def\removeemptybraces\empty#1\relax{\def\tptemp{#1}}% +% braces (if any). That's what this does. +% +\def\removeemptybraces\empty#1\relax{#1} % After \spacesplit has done its work, this is called -- #1 is the final % thing to call, #2 the type name (which starts with \empty), and #3 % (which might be empty) the arguments. -% +% \def\parsetpheaderline#1#2#3{% - \removeemptybraces#2\relax - #1{\tptemp}{#3}% + #1{\removeemptybraces#2\relax}{#3}% }% -\def\defopvarparsebody #1#2#3#4#5 {\begingroup\inENV % -\medbreak % -% Define the end token that this defining construct specifies -% so that it will exit this group. -\def#1{\endgraf\endgroup\medbreak}% -\def#2##1 ##2 {\def#4{##1}% -\begingroup\obeylines\spacesplit{#3{##2}}}% -\parindent=0in -\advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent \advance \rightskip by \defbodyindent -\exdentamount=\defbodyindent -\begingroup\obeylines\spacesplit{#3{#5}}} - -% Split up #2 at the first space token. +% Split up #2 (the rest of the input line) at the first space token. % call #1 with two arguments: % the first is all of #2 before the space token, % the second is all of #2 after that space token. % If #2 contains no space token, all of it is passed as the first arg % and the second is passed as empty. - -{\obeylines -\gdef\spacesplit#1#2^^M{\endgroup\spacesplitfoo{#1}#2 \relax\spacesplitfoo}% -\long\gdef\spacesplitfoo#1#2 #3#4\spacesplitfoo{% -\ifx\relax #3% -#1{#2}{}\else #1{#2}{#3#4}\fi}} - -% So much for the things common to all kinds of definitions. +% +{\obeylines % + \gdef\spacesplit#1#2^^M{\endgroup\spacesplitx{#1}#2 \relax\spacesplitx}% + \long\gdef\spacesplitx#1#2 #3#4\spacesplitx{% + \ifx\relax #3% + #1{#2}{}% + \else % + #1{#2}{#3#4}% + \fi}% +} % Define @defun. -% First, define the processing that is wanted for arguments of \defun -% Use this to expand the args and terminate the paragraph they make up +% This is called to end the arguments processing for all the @def... commands. +% +\def\defargscommonending{% + \interlinepenalty = 10000 + \advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fil + \endgraf + \nobreak\vskip -\parskip + \penalty 10002 % signal to \parsebodycommon and \defxbodycommon. +} -\def\defunargs #1{\functionparens \sl +% This expands the args and terminates the paragraph they comprise. +% +\def\defunargs#1{\functionparens \sl % Expand, preventing hyphenation at `-' chars. % Note that groups don't affect changes in \hyphenchar. -\hyphenchar\tensl=0 +% Set the font temporarily and use \font in case \setfont made \tensl a macro. +{\tensl\hyphenchar\font=0}% #1% -\hyphenchar\tensl=45 -\ifnum\parencount=0 \else \errmessage{unbalanced parens in @def arguments}\fi% -\interlinepenalty=10000 -\advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fil -\endgraf\penalty 10000\vskip -\parskip\penalty 10000% +{\tensl\hyphenchar\font=45}% +\ifnum\parencount=0 \else \errmessage{Unbalanced parentheses in @def}\fi% + \defargscommonending } \def\deftypefunargs #1{% @@ -3573,9 +5268,7 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi % Use \boldbraxnoamp, not \functionparens, so that & is not special. \boldbraxnoamp \tclose{#1}% avoid \code because of side effects on active chars -\interlinepenalty=10000 -\advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fil -\endgraf\penalty 10000\vskip -\parskip\penalty 10000% + \defargscommonending } % Do complete processing of one @defun or @defunx line already parsed. @@ -3586,7 +5279,7 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi \def\deffnheader #1#2#3{\doind {fn}{\code{#2}}% \begingroup\defname {#2}{#1}\defunargs{#3}\endgroup % -\catcode 61=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody +\catcode\equalChar=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody } % @defun == @deffn Function @@ -3594,9 +5287,9 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi \def\defun{\defparsebody\Edefun\defunx\defunheader} \def\defunheader #1#2{\doind {fn}{\code{#1}}% Make entry in function index -\begingroup\defname {#1}{Function}% +\begingroup\defname {#1}{\putwordDeffunc}% \defunargs {#2}\endgroup % -\catcode 61=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody +\catcode\equalChar=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody } % @deftypefun int foobar (int @var{foo}, float @var{bar}) @@ -3608,18 +5301,18 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi % #1 is the data type, #2 the name, #3 the args. \def\deftypefunheaderx #1#2 #3\relax{% \doind {fn}{\code{#2}}% Make entry in function index -\begingroup\defname {\defheaderxcond#1\relax$$$#2}{Function}% +\begingroup\defname {\defheaderxcond#1\relax$.$#2}{\putwordDeftypefun}% \deftypefunargs {#3}\endgroup % -\catcode 61=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody +\catcode\equalChar=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody } % @deftypefn {Library Function} int foobar (int @var{foo}, float @var{bar}) \def\deftypefn{\defmethparsebody\Edeftypefn\deftypefnx\deftypefnheader} -% \defheaderxcond#1\relax$$$ +% \defheaderxcond#1\relax$.$ % puts #1 in @code, followed by a space, but does nothing if #1 is null. -\def\defheaderxcond#1#2$$${\ifx#1\relax\else\code{#1#2} \fi} +\def\defheaderxcond#1#2$.${\ifx#1\relax\else\code{#1#2} \fi} % #1 is the classification. #2 is the data type. #3 is the name and args. \def\deftypefnheader #1#2#3{\deftypefnheaderx{#1}{#2}#3 \relax} @@ -3629,9 +5322,9 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi \begingroup \normalparens % notably, turn off `&' magic, which prevents % at least some C++ text from working -\defname {\defheaderxcond#2\relax$$$#3}{#1}% +\defname {\defheaderxcond#2\relax$.$#3}{#1}% \deftypefunargs {#4}\endgroup % -\catcode 61=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody +\catcode\equalChar=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody } % @defmac == @deffn Macro @@ -3639,9 +5332,9 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi \def\defmac{\defparsebody\Edefmac\defmacx\defmacheader} \def\defmacheader #1#2{\doind {fn}{\code{#1}}% Make entry in function index -\begingroup\defname {#1}{Macro}% +\begingroup\defname {#1}{\putwordDefmac}% \defunargs {#2}\endgroup % -\catcode 61=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody +\catcode\equalChar=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody } % @defspec == @deffn Special Form @@ -3649,42 +5342,80 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi \def\defspec{\defparsebody\Edefspec\defspecx\defspecheader} \def\defspecheader #1#2{\doind {fn}{\code{#1}}% Make entry in function index -\begingroup\defname {#1}{Special Form}% +\begingroup\defname {#1}{\putwordDefspec}% \defunargs {#2}\endgroup % -\catcode 61=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody +\catcode\equalChar=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody } -% This definition is run if you use @defunx -% anywhere other than immediately after a @defun or @defunx. - -\def\deffnx #1 {\errmessage{@deffnx in invalid context}} -\def\defunx #1 {\errmessage{@defunx in invalid context}} -\def\defmacx #1 {\errmessage{@defmacx in invalid context}} -\def\defspecx #1 {\errmessage{@defspecx in invalid context}} -\def\deftypefnx #1 {\errmessage{@deftypefnx in invalid context}} -\def\deftypeunx #1 {\errmessage{@deftypeunx in invalid context}} - -% @defmethod, and so on - -% @defop {Funny Method} foo-class frobnicate argument - +% @defop CATEGORY CLASS OPERATION ARG... +% \def\defop #1 {\def\defoptype{#1}% \defopparsebody\Edefop\defopx\defopheader\defoptype} +% +\def\defopheader#1#2#3{% + \dosubind{fn}{\code{#2}}{\putwordon\ \code{#1}}% function index entry + \begingroup + \defname{#2}{\defoptype\ \putwordon\ #1}% + \defunargs{#3}% + \endgroup +} + +% @deftypeop CATEGORY CLASS TYPE OPERATION ARG... +% +\def\deftypeop #1 {\def\deftypeopcategory{#1}% + \deftypeopparsebody\Edeftypeop\deftypeopx\deftypeopheader + \deftypeopcategory} +% +% #1 is the class name, #2 the data type, #3 the operation name, #4 the args. +\def\deftypeopheader#1#2#3#4{% + \dosubind{fn}{\code{#3}}{\putwordon\ \code{#1}}% entry in function index + \begingroup + \defname{\defheaderxcond#2\relax$.$#3} + {\deftypeopcategory\ \putwordon\ \code{#1}}% + \deftypefunargs{#4}% + \endgroup +} + +% @deftypemethod CLASS TYPE METHOD ARG... +% +\def\deftypemethod{% + \deftypemethparsebody\Edeftypemethod\deftypemethodx\deftypemethodheader} +% +% #1 is the class name, #2 the data type, #3 the method name, #4 the args. +\def\deftypemethodheader#1#2#3#4{% + \dosubind{fn}{\code{#3}}{\putwordon\ \code{#1}}% entry in function index + \begingroup + \defname{\defheaderxcond#2\relax$.$#3}{\putwordMethodon\ \code{#1}}% + \deftypefunargs{#4}% + \endgroup +} -\def\defopheader #1#2#3{% -\dosubind {fn}{\code{#2}}{on #1}% Make entry in function index -\begingroup\defname {#2}{\defoptype{} on #1}% -\defunargs {#3}\endgroup % +% @deftypeivar CLASS TYPE VARNAME +% +\def\deftypeivar{% + \deftypemethparsebody\Edeftypeivar\deftypeivarx\deftypeivarheader} +% +% #1 is the class name, #2 the data type, #3 the variable name. +\def\deftypeivarheader#1#2#3{% + \dosubind{vr}{\code{#3}}{\putwordof\ \code{#1}}% entry in variable index + \begingroup + \defname{\defheaderxcond#2\relax$.$#3} + {\putwordInstanceVariableof\ \code{#1}}% + \defvarargs{#3}% + \endgroup } % @defmethod == @defop Method - +% \def\defmethod{\defmethparsebody\Edefmethod\defmethodx\defmethodheader} - -\def\defmethodheader #1#2#3{% -\dosubind {fn}{\code{#2}}{on #1}% entry in function index -\begingroup\defname {#2}{Method on #1}% -\defunargs {#3}\endgroup % +% +% #1 is the class name, #2 the method name, #3 the args. +\def\defmethodheader#1#2#3{% + \dosubind{fn}{\code{#2}}{\putwordon\ \code{#1}}% entry in function index + \begingroup + \defname{#2}{\putwordMethodon\ \code{#1}}% + \defunargs{#3}% + \endgroup } % @defcv {Class Option} foo-class foo-flag @@ -3693,37 +5424,32 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi \defopvarparsebody\Edefcv\defcvx\defcvarheader\defcvtype} \def\defcvarheader #1#2#3{% -\dosubind {vr}{\code{#2}}{of #1}% Make entry in var index -\begingroup\defname {#2}{\defcvtype{} of #1}% -\defvarargs {#3}\endgroup % + \dosubind{vr}{\code{#2}}{\putwordof\ \code{#1}}% variable index entry + \begingroup + \defname{#2}{\defcvtype\ \putwordof\ #1}% + \defvarargs{#3}% + \endgroup } -% @defivar == @defcv {Instance Variable} - +% @defivar CLASS VARNAME == @defcv {Instance Variable} CLASS VARNAME +% \def\defivar{\defvrparsebody\Edefivar\defivarx\defivarheader} - -\def\defivarheader #1#2#3{% -\dosubind {vr}{\code{#2}}{of #1}% Make entry in var index -\begingroup\defname {#2}{Instance Variable of #1}% -\defvarargs {#3}\endgroup % +% +\def\defivarheader#1#2#3{% + \dosubind{vr}{\code{#2}}{\putwordof\ \code{#1}}% entry in var index + \begingroup + \defname{#2}{\putwordInstanceVariableof\ #1}% + \defvarargs{#3}% + \endgroup } -% These definitions are run if you use @defmethodx, etc., -% anywhere other than immediately after a @defmethod, etc. - -\def\defopx #1 {\errmessage{@defopx in invalid context}} -\def\defmethodx #1 {\errmessage{@defmethodx in invalid context}} -\def\defcvx #1 {\errmessage{@defcvx in invalid context}} -\def\defivarx #1 {\errmessage{@defivarx in invalid context}} - -% Now @defvar - +% @defvar % First, define the processing that is wanted for arguments of @defvar. % This is actually simple: just print them in roman. % This must expand the args and terminate the paragraph they make up \def\defvarargs #1{\normalparens #1% -\interlinepenalty=10000 -\endgraf\penalty 10000\vskip -\parskip\penalty 10000} + \defargscommonending +} % @defvr Counter foo-count @@ -3737,7 +5463,7 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi \def\defvar{\defvarparsebody\Edefvar\defvarx\defvarheader} \def\defvarheader #1#2{\doind {vr}{\code{#1}}% Make entry in var index -\begingroup\defname {#1}{Variable}% +\begingroup\defname {#1}{\putwordDefvar}% \defvarargs {#2}\endgroup % } @@ -3746,7 +5472,7 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi \def\defopt{\defvarparsebody\Edefopt\defoptx\defoptheader} \def\defoptheader #1#2{\doind {vr}{\code{#1}}% Make entry in var index -\begingroup\defname {#1}{User Option}% +\begingroup\defname {#1}{\putwordDefopt}% \defvarargs {#2}\endgroup % } @@ -3754,33 +5480,24 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi \def\deftypevar{\defvarparsebody\Edeftypevar\deftypevarx\deftypevarheader} -% #1 is the data type. #2 is the name. +% #1 is the data type. #2 is the name, perhaps followed by text that +% is actually part of the data type, which should not be put into the index. \def\deftypevarheader #1#2{% -\doind {vr}{\code{#2}}% Make entry in variables index -\begingroup\defname {\defheaderxcond#1\relax$$$#2}{Variable}% -\interlinepenalty=10000 -\endgraf\penalty 10000\vskip -\parskip\penalty 10000 +\dovarind#2 \relax% Make entry in variables index +\begingroup\defname {\defheaderxcond#1\relax$.$#2}{\putwordDeftypevar}% + \defargscommonending \endgroup} +\def\dovarind#1 #2\relax{\doind{vr}{\code{#1}}} % @deftypevr {Global Flag} int enable \def\deftypevr{\defvrparsebody\Edeftypevr\deftypevrx\deftypevrheader} -\def\deftypevrheader #1#2#3{\doind {vr}{\code{#3}}% -\begingroup\defname {\defheaderxcond#2\relax$$$#3}{#1} -\interlinepenalty=10000 -\endgraf\penalty 10000\vskip -\parskip\penalty 10000 +\def\deftypevrheader #1#2#3{\dovarind#3 \relax% +\begingroup\defname {\defheaderxcond#2\relax$.$#3}{#1} + \defargscommonending \endgroup} -% This definition is run if you use @defvarx -% anywhere other than immediately after a @defvar or @defvarx. - -\def\defvrx #1 {\errmessage{@defvrx in invalid context}} -\def\defvarx #1 {\errmessage{@defvarx in invalid context}} -\def\defoptx #1 {\errmessage{@defoptx in invalid context}} -\def\deftypevarx #1 {\errmessage{@deftypevarx in invalid context}} -\def\deftypevrx #1 {\errmessage{@deftypevrx in invalid context}} - % Now define @deftp % Args are printed in bold, a slight difference from @defvar. @@ -3793,70 +5510,417 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi \def\deftpheader #1#2#3{\doind {tp}{\code{#2}}% \begingroup\defname {#2}{#1}\deftpargs{#3}\endgroup} -% This definition is run if you use @deftpx, etc -% anywhere other than immediately after a @deftp, etc. +% These definitions are used if you use @defunx (etc.) +% anywhere other than immediately after a @defun or @defunx. +% +\def\defcvx#1 {\errmessage{@defcvx in invalid context}} +\def\deffnx#1 {\errmessage{@deffnx in invalid context}} +\def\defivarx#1 {\errmessage{@defivarx in invalid context}} +\def\defmacx#1 {\errmessage{@defmacx in invalid context}} +\def\defmethodx#1 {\errmessage{@defmethodx in invalid context}} +\def\defoptx #1 {\errmessage{@defoptx in invalid context}} +\def\defopx#1 {\errmessage{@defopx in invalid context}} +\def\defspecx#1 {\errmessage{@defspecx in invalid context}} +\def\deftpx#1 {\errmessage{@deftpx in invalid context}} +\def\deftypefnx#1 {\errmessage{@deftypefnx in invalid context}} +\def\deftypefunx#1 {\errmessage{@deftypefunx in invalid context}} +\def\deftypeivarx#1 {\errmessage{@deftypeivarx in invalid context}} +\def\deftypemethodx#1 {\errmessage{@deftypemethodx in invalid context}} +\def\deftypeopx#1 {\errmessage{@deftypeopx in invalid context}} +\def\deftypevarx#1 {\errmessage{@deftypevarx in invalid context}} +\def\deftypevrx#1 {\errmessage{@deftypevrx in invalid context}} +\def\defunx#1 {\errmessage{@defunx in invalid context}} +\def\defvarx#1 {\errmessage{@defvarx in invalid context}} +\def\defvrx#1 {\errmessage{@defvrx in invalid context}} + + +\message{macros,} +% @macro. + +% To do this right we need a feature of e-TeX, \scantokens, +% which we arrange to emulate with a temporary file in ordinary TeX. +\ifx\eTeXversion\undefined + \newwrite\macscribble + \def\scanmacro#1{% + \begingroup \newlinechar`\^^M + % Undo catcode changes of \startcontents and \doprintindex + \catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\other \escapechar=`\@ + % Append \endinput to make sure that TeX does not see the ending newline. + \toks0={#1\endinput}% + \immediate\openout\macscribble=\jobname.tmp + \immediate\write\macscribble{\the\toks0}% + \immediate\closeout\macscribble + \let\xeatspaces\eatspaces + \input \jobname.tmp + \endgroup +} +\else +\def\scanmacro#1{% +\begingroup \newlinechar`\^^M +% Undo catcode changes of \startcontents and \doprintindex +\catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\other \escapechar=`\@ +\let\xeatspaces\eatspaces\scantokens{#1\endinput}\endgroup} +\fi + +\newcount\paramno % Count of parameters +\newtoks\macname % Macro name +\newif\ifrecursive % Is it recursive? +\def\macrolist{} % List of all defined macros in the form + % \do\macro1\do\macro2... + +% Utility routines. +% Thisdoes \let #1 = #2, except with \csnames. +\def\cslet#1#2{% +\expandafter\expandafter +\expandafter\let +\expandafter\expandafter +\csname#1\endcsname +\csname#2\endcsname} + +% Trim leading and trailing spaces off a string. +% Concepts from aro-bend problem 15 (see CTAN). +{\catcode`\@=11 +\gdef\eatspaces #1{\expandafter\trim@\expandafter{#1 }} +\gdef\trim@ #1{\trim@@ @#1 @ #1 @ @@} +\gdef\trim@@ #1@ #2@ #3@@{\trim@@@\empty #2 @} +\def\unbrace#1{#1} +\unbrace{\gdef\trim@@@ #1 } #2@{#1} +} + +% Trim a single trailing ^^M off a string. +{\catcode`\^^M=\other \catcode`\Q=3% +\gdef\eatcr #1{\eatcra #1Q^^MQ}% +\gdef\eatcra#1^^MQ{\eatcrb#1Q}% +\gdef\eatcrb#1Q#2Q{#1}% +} + +% Macro bodies are absorbed as an argument in a context where +% all characters are catcode 10, 11 or 12, except \ which is active +% (as in normal texinfo). It is necessary to change the definition of \. + +% It's necessary to have hard CRs when the macro is executed. This is +% done by making ^^M (\endlinechar) catcode 12 when reading the macro +% body, and then making it the \newlinechar in \scanmacro. + +\def\macrobodyctxt{% + \catcode`\~=\other + \catcode`\^=\other + \catcode`\_=\other + \catcode`\|=\other + \catcode`\<=\other + \catcode`\>=\other + \catcode`\+=\other + \catcode`\{=\other + \catcode`\}=\other + \catcode`\@=\other + \catcode`\^^M=\other + \usembodybackslash} + +\def\macroargctxt{% + \catcode`\~=\other + \catcode`\^=\other + \catcode`\_=\other + \catcode`\|=\other + \catcode`\<=\other + \catcode`\>=\other + \catcode`\+=\other + \catcode`\@=\other + \catcode`\\=\other} + +% \mbodybackslash is the definition of \ in @macro bodies. +% It maps \foo\ => \csname macarg.foo\endcsname => #N +% where N is the macro parameter number. +% We define \csname macarg.\endcsname to be \realbackslash, so +% \\ in macro replacement text gets you a backslash. + +{\catcode`@=0 @catcode`@\=@active + @gdef@usembodybackslash{@let\=@mbodybackslash} + @gdef@mbodybackslash#1\{@csname macarg.#1@endcsname} +} +\expandafter\def\csname macarg.\endcsname{\realbackslash} + +\def\macro{\recursivefalse\parsearg\macroxxx} +\def\rmacro{\recursivetrue\parsearg\macroxxx} + +\def\macroxxx#1{% + \getargs{#1}% now \macname is the macname and \argl the arglist + \ifx\argl\empty % no arguments + \paramno=0% + \else + \expandafter\parsemargdef \argl;% + \fi + \if1\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname + \message{Warning: redefining \the\macname}% + \else + \expandafter\ifx\csname \the\macname\endcsname \relax + \else \errmessage{Macro name \the\macname\space already defined}\fi + \global\cslet{macsave.\the\macname}{\the\macname}% + \global\expandafter\let\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname=1% + % Add the macroname to \macrolist + \toks0 = \expandafter{\macrolist\do}% + \xdef\macrolist{\the\toks0 + \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname\endcsname}% + \fi + \begingroup \macrobodyctxt + \ifrecursive \expandafter\parsermacbody + \else \expandafter\parsemacbody + \fi} + +\def\unmacro{\parsearg\dounmacro} +\def\dounmacro#1{% + \if1\csname ismacro.#1\endcsname + \global\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}% + \global\expandafter\let \csname ismacro.#1\endcsname=0% + % Remove the macro name from \macrolist: + \begingroup + \expandafter\let\csname#1\endcsname \relax + \let\do\unmacrodo + \xdef\macrolist{\macrolist}% + \endgroup + \else + \errmessage{Macro #1 not defined}% + \fi +} + +% Called by \do from \dounmacro on each macro. The idea is to omit any +% macro definitions that have been changed to \relax. +% +\def\unmacrodo#1{% + \ifx#1\relax + % remove this + \else + \noexpand\do \noexpand #1% + \fi +} + +% This makes use of the obscure feature that if the last token of a +% is #, then the preceding argument is delimited by +% an opening brace, and that opening brace is not consumed. +\def\getargs#1{\getargsxxx#1{}} +\def\getargsxxx#1#{\getmacname #1 \relax\getmacargs} +\def\getmacname #1 #2\relax{\macname={#1}} +\def\getmacargs#1{\def\argl{#1}} + +% Parse the optional {params} list. Set up \paramno and \paramlist +% so \defmacro knows what to do. Define \macarg.blah for each blah +% in the params list, to be ##N where N is the position in that list. +% That gets used by \mbodybackslash (above). + +% We need to get `macro parameter char #' into several definitions. +% The technique used is stolen from LaTeX: let \hash be something +% unexpandable, insert that wherever you need a #, and then redefine +% it to # just before using the token list produced. +% +% The same technique is used to protect \eatspaces till just before +% the macro is used. + +\def\parsemargdef#1;{\paramno=0\def\paramlist{}% + \let\hash\relax\let\xeatspaces\relax\parsemargdefxxx#1,;,} +\def\parsemargdefxxx#1,{% + \if#1;\let\next=\relax + \else \let\next=\parsemargdefxxx + \advance\paramno by 1% + \expandafter\edef\csname macarg.\eatspaces{#1}\endcsname + {\xeatspaces{\hash\the\paramno}}% + \edef\paramlist{\paramlist\hash\the\paramno,}% + \fi\next} + +% These two commands read recursive and nonrecursive macro bodies. +% (They're different since rec and nonrec macros end differently.) + +\long\def\parsemacbody#1@end macro% +{\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}% +\long\def\parsermacbody#1@end rmacro% +{\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}% + +% This defines the macro itself. There are six cases: recursive and +% nonrecursive macros of zero, one, and many arguments. +% Much magic with \expandafter here. +% \xdef is used so that macro definitions will survive the file +% they're defined in; @include reads the file inside a group. +\def\defmacro{% + \let\hash=##% convert placeholders to macro parameter chars + \ifrecursive + \ifcase\paramno + % 0 + \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% + \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}% + \or % 1 + \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% + \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt + \noexpand\braceorline + \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}% + \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{% + \egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}% + \else % many + \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% + \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt + \noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}% + \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{% + \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}% + \expandafter\expandafter + \expandafter\xdef + \expandafter\expandafter + \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname + \paramlist{\egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}% + \fi + \else + \ifcase\paramno + % 0 + \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% + \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}% + \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}% + \or % 1 + \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% + \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt + \noexpand\braceorline + \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}% + \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{% + \egroup + \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}% + \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}% + \else % many + \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% + \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt + \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}% + \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{% + \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}% + \expandafter\expandafter + \expandafter\xdef + \expandafter\expandafter + \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname + \paramlist{% + \egroup + \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}% + \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}% + \fi + \fi} + +\def\norecurse#1{\bgroup\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}} + +% \braceorline decides whether the next nonwhitespace character is a +% {. If so it reads up to the closing }, if not, it reads the whole +% line. Whatever was read is then fed to the next control sequence +% as an argument (by \parsebrace or \parsearg) +\def\braceorline#1{\let\next=#1\futurelet\nchar\braceorlinexxx} +\def\braceorlinexxx{% + \ifx\nchar\bgroup\else + \expandafter\parsearg + \fi \next} + +% We mant to disable all macros during \shipout so that they are not +% expanded by \write. +\def\turnoffmacros{\begingroup \def\do##1{\let\noexpand##1=\relax}% + \edef\next{\macrolist}\expandafter\endgroup\next} + -\def\deftpx #1 {\errmessage{@deftpx in invalid context}} +% @alias. +% We need some trickery to remove the optional spaces around the equal +% sign. Just make them active and then expand them all to nothing. +\def\alias{\begingroup\obeyspaces\parsearg\aliasxxx} +\def\aliasxxx #1{\aliasyyy#1\relax} +\def\aliasyyy #1=#2\relax{\ignoreactivespaces +\edef\next{\global\let\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname=% + \expandafter\noexpand\csname#2\endcsname}% +\expandafter\endgroup\next} -\message{cross reference,} -% Define cross-reference macros -\newwrite \auxfile -\newif\ifhavexrefs % True if xref values are known. +\message{cross references,} + +\newwrite\auxfile + +\newif\ifhavexrefs % True if xref values are known. \newif\ifwarnedxrefs % True if we warned once that they aren't known. -% \setref{foo} defines a cross-reference point named foo. +% @inforef is relatively simple. +\def\inforef #1{\inforefzzz #1,,,,**} +\def\inforefzzz #1,#2,#3,#4**{\putwordSee{} \putwordInfo{} \putwordfile{} \file{\ignorespaces #3{}}, + node \samp{\ignorespaces#1{}}} -\def\setref#1{% -\dosetq{#1-title}{Ytitle}% -\dosetq{#1-pg}{Ypagenumber}% -\dosetq{#1-snt}{Ysectionnumberandtype}} +% @node's only job in TeX is to define \lastnode, which is used in +% cross-references. +\def\node{\ENVcheck\parsearg\nodezzz} +\def\nodezzz#1{\nodexxx #1,\finishnodeparse} +\def\nodexxx#1,#2\finishnodeparse{\gdef\lastnode{#1}} +\let\nwnode=\node +\let\lastnode=\empty -\def\unnumbsetref#1{% -\dosetq{#1-title}{Ytitle}% -\dosetq{#1-pg}{Ypagenumber}% -\dosetq{#1-snt}{Ynothing}} +% Write a cross-reference definition for the current node. #1 is the +% type (Ynumbered, Yappendix, Ynothing). +% +\def\donoderef#1{% + \ifx\lastnode\empty\else + \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\setref{\lastnode}{#1}% + \global\let\lastnode=\empty + \fi +} -\def\appendixsetref#1{% -\dosetq{#1-title}{Ytitle}% -\dosetq{#1-pg}{Ypagenumber}% -\dosetq{#1-snt}{Yappendixletterandtype}} +% @anchor{NAME} -- define xref target at arbitrary point. +% +\newcount\savesfregister +% +\gdef\savesf{\relax \ifhmode \savesfregister=\spacefactor \fi} +\gdef\restoresf{\relax \ifhmode \spacefactor=\savesfregister \fi} +\gdef\anchor#1{\savesf \setref{#1}{Ynothing}\restoresf \ignorespaces} + +% \setref{NAME}{SNT} defines a cross-reference point NAME (a node or an +% anchor), namely NAME-title (the corresponding @chapter/etc. name), +% NAME-pg (the page number), and NAME-snt (section number and type). +% Called from \foonoderef. +% +% We have to set dummies so commands such as @code in a section title +% aren't expanded. It would be nicer not to expand the titles in the +% first place, but that is hard to do. +% +% Likewise, use \turnoffactive so that punctuation chars such as underscore +% and backslash work in node names. +% +\def\setref#1#2{{% + \atdummies + \pdfmkdest{#1}% + % + \iflinks + \turnoffactive + \dosetq{#1-title}{Ytitle}% + \dosetq{#1-pg}{Ypagenumber}% + \dosetq{#1-snt}{#2}% + \fi +}} -% \xref, \pxref, and \ref generate cross-references to specified points. -% For \xrefX, #1 is the node name, #2 the name of the Info -% cross-reference, #3 the printed node name, #4 the name of the Info -% file, #5 the name of the printed manual. All but the node name can be -% omitted. +% @xref, @pxref, and @ref generate cross-references. For \xrefX, #1 is +% the node name, #2 the name of the Info cross-reference, #3 the printed +% node name, #4 the name of the Info file, #5 the name of the printed +% manual. All but the node name can be omitted. % \def\pxref#1{\putwordsee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]} \def\xref#1{\putwordSee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]} \def\ref#1{\xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]} \def\xrefX[#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6]{\begingroup + \unsepspaces \def\printedmanual{\ignorespaces #5}% \def\printednodename{\ignorespaces #3}% \setbox1=\hbox{\printedmanual}% \setbox0=\hbox{\printednodename}% \ifdim \wd0 = 0pt % No printed node name was explicitly given. - \ifx\SETxref-automatic-section-title\relax % + \expandafter\ifx\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname\relax + % Use the node name inside the square brackets. + \def\printednodename{\ignorespaces #1}% + \else % Use the actual chapter/section title appear inside % the square brackets. Use the real section title if we have it. - \ifdim \wd1>0pt% + \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt % It is in another manual, so we don't have it. \def\printednodename{\ignorespaces #1}% \else \ifhavexrefs % We know the real title if we have the xref values. - \def\printednodename{\refx{#1-title}}% + \def\printednodename{\refx{#1-title}{}}% \else % Otherwise just copy the Info node name. \def\printednodename{\ignorespaces #1}% \fi% \fi - \def\printednodename{#1-title}% - \else - % Use the node name inside the square brackets. - \def\printednodename{\ignorespaces #1}% \fi \fi % @@ -3866,171 +5930,227 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi % are best written with fairly long node names, containing hyphens, this % is a loss. Therefore, we give the text of the node name again, so it % is as if TeX is seeing it for the first time. + \ifpdf + \leavevmode + \getfilename{#4}% + {\turnoffactive \otherbackslash + \ifnum\filenamelength>0 + \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}% + goto file{\the\filename.pdf} name{#1}% + \else + \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}% + goto name{\pdfmkpgn{#1}}% + \fi + }% + \linkcolor + \fi + % \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt - \putwordsection{} ``\printednodename'' in \cite{\printedmanual}% + \putwordsection{} ``\printednodename'' \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}% \else % _ (for example) has to be the character _ for the purposes of the % control sequence corresponding to the node, but it has to expand % into the usual \leavevmode...\vrule stuff for purposes of % printing. So we \turnoffactive for the \refx-snt, back on for the % printing, back off for the \refx-pg. - {\turnoffactive \refx{#1-snt}{}}% - \space [\printednodename],\space - \turnoffactive \putwordpage\tie\refx{#1-pg}{}% + {\turnoffactive \otherbackslash + % Only output a following space if the -snt ref is nonempty; for + % @unnumbered and @anchor, it won't be. + \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \refx{#1-snt}{}}% + \ifdim \wd2 > 0pt \refx{#1-snt}\space\fi + }% + % output the `[mynode]' via a macro. + \xrefprintnodename\printednodename + % + % But we always want a comma and a space: + ,\space + % + % output the `page 3'. + \turnoffactive \otherbackslash \putwordpage\tie\refx{#1-pg}{}% \fi + \endlink \endgroup} -% \dosetq is the interface for calls from other macros - -% Use \turnoffactive so that punctuation chars such as underscore -% work in node names. -\def\dosetq #1#2{{\let\folio=0 \turnoffactive \auxhat% -\edef\next{\write\auxfile{\internalsetq {#1}{#2}}}% -\next}} - -% \internalsetq {foo}{page} expands into -% CHARACTERS 'xrdef {foo}{...expansion of \Ypage...} -% When the aux file is read, ' is the escape character - -\def\internalsetq #1#2{'xrdef {#1}{\csname #2\endcsname}} +% This macro is called from \xrefX for the `[nodename]' part of xref +% output. It's a separate macro only so it can be changed more easily, +% since not square brackets don't work in some documents. Particularly +% one that Bob is working on :). +% +\def\xrefprintnodename#1{[#1]} -% Things to be expanded by \internalsetq +% \dosetq is called from \setref to do the actual \write (\iflinks). +% +\def\dosetq#1#2{% + \edef\next{\write\auxfile{\internalsetq{#1}{#2}}}% + \next +} -\def\Ypagenumber{\folio} +% \internalsetq{foo}{page} expands into +% CHARACTERS @xrdef{foo}{...expansion of \page...} +\def\internalsetq#1#2{@xrdef{#1}{\csname #2\endcsname}} +% Things to be expanded by \internalsetq. +% +\def\Ypagenumber{\noexpand\folio} \def\Ytitle{\thissection} - \def\Ynothing{} - -\def\Ysectionnumberandtype{% -\ifnum\secno=0 \putwordChapter\xreftie\the\chapno % -\else \ifnum \subsecno=0 \putwordSection\xreftie\the\chapno.\the\secno % -\else \ifnum \subsubsecno=0 % -\putwordSection\xreftie\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno % -\else % -\putwordSection\xreftie\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno % -\fi \fi \fi } - -\def\Yappendixletterandtype{% -\ifnum\secno=0 \putwordAppendix\xreftie'char\the\appendixno{}% -\else \ifnum \subsecno=0 \putwordSection\xreftie'char\the\appendixno.\the\secno % -\else \ifnum \subsubsecno=0 % -\putwordSection\xreftie'char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno % -\else % -\putwordSection\xreftie'char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno % -\fi \fi \fi } - -\gdef\xreftie{'tie} +\def\Yomitfromtoc{} +\def\Ynumbered{% + \ifnum\secno=0 + \putwordChapter@tie \the\chapno + \else \ifnum\subsecno=0 + \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno + \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0 + \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno + \else + \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno + \fi\fi\fi +} +\def\Yappendix{% + \ifnum\secno=0 + \putwordAppendix@tie @char\the\appendixno{}% + \else \ifnum\subsecno=0 + \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno + \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0 + \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno + \else + \putwordSection@tie + @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno + \fi\fi\fi +} % Use TeX 3.0's \inputlineno to get the line number, for better error % messages, but if we're using an old version of TeX, don't do anything. % \ifx\inputlineno\thisisundefined - \let\linenumber = \empty % Non-3.0. + \let\linenumber = \empty % Pre-3.0. \else \def\linenumber{\the\inputlineno:\space} \fi % Define \refx{NAME}{SUFFIX} to reference a cross-reference string named NAME. % If its value is nonempty, SUFFIX is output afterward. - +% \def\refx#1#2{% - \expandafter\ifx\csname X#1\endcsname\relax + {% + \indexnofonts + \otherbackslash + \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\thisrefX + \csname X#1\endcsname + }% + \ifx\thisrefX\relax % If not defined, say something at least. - $\langle$un\-de\-fined$\rangle$% - \ifhavexrefs - \message{\linenumber Undefined cross reference `#1'.}% - \else - \ifwarnedxrefs\else - \global\warnedxrefstrue - \message{Cross reference values unknown; you must run TeX again.}% + \angleleft un\-de\-fined\angleright + \iflinks + \ifhavexrefs + \message{\linenumber Undefined cross reference `#1'.}% + \else + \ifwarnedxrefs\else + \global\warnedxrefstrue + \message{Cross reference values unknown; you must run TeX again.}% + \fi \fi \fi \else % It's defined, so just use it. - \csname X#1\endcsname + \thisrefX \fi #2% Output the suffix in any case. } -% Read the last existing aux file, if any. No error if none exists. - % This is the macro invoked by entries in the aux file. -\def\xrdef #1#2{ -{\catcode`\'=\other\expandafter \gdef \csname X#1\endcsname {#2}}} +% +\def\xrdef#1{\expandafter\gdef\csname X#1\endcsname} -\def\readauxfile{% -\begingroup -\catcode `\^^@=\other -\catcode `\=\other -\catcode `\=\other -\catcode `\^^C=\other -\catcode `\^^D=\other -\catcode `\^^E=\other -\catcode `\^^F=\other -\catcode `\^^G=\other -\catcode `\^^H=\other -\catcode `\ =\other -\catcode `\^^L=\other -\catcode `\=\other -\catcode `\=\other -\catcode `\=\other -\catcode `\=\other -\catcode `\=\other -\catcode `\=\other -\catcode `\=\other -\catcode `\=\other -\catcode `\=\other -\catcode `\=\other -\catcode `\=\other -\catcode `\=\other -\catcode 26=\other -\catcode `\^^[=\other -\catcode `\^^\=\other -\catcode `\^^]=\other -\catcode `\^^^=\other -\catcode `\^^_=\other -\catcode `\@=\other -\catcode `\^=\other -\catcode `\~=\other -\catcode `\[=\other -\catcode `\]=\other -\catcode`\"=\other -\catcode`\_=\other -\catcode`\|=\other -\catcode`\<=\other -\catcode`\>=\other -\catcode `\$=\other -\catcode `\#=\other -\catcode `\&=\other -% `\+ does not work, so use 43. -\catcode 43=\other -% Make the characters 128-255 be printing characters -{% - \count 1=128 - \def\loop{% - \catcode\count 1=\other - \advance\count 1 by 1 - \ifnum \count 1<256 \loop \fi +% Read the last existing aux file, if any. No error if none exists. +\def\readauxfile{\begingroup + \catcode`\^^@=\other + \catcode`\^^A=\other + \catcode`\^^B=\other + \catcode`\^^C=\other + \catcode`\^^D=\other + \catcode`\^^E=\other + \catcode`\^^F=\other + \catcode`\^^G=\other + \catcode`\^^H=\other + \catcode`\^^K=\other + \catcode`\^^L=\other + \catcode`\^^N=\other + \catcode`\^^P=\other + \catcode`\^^Q=\other + \catcode`\^^R=\other + \catcode`\^^S=\other + \catcode`\^^T=\other + \catcode`\^^U=\other + \catcode`\^^V=\other + \catcode`\^^W=\other + \catcode`\^^X=\other + \catcode`\^^Z=\other + \catcode`\^^[=\other + \catcode`\^^\=\other + \catcode`\^^]=\other + \catcode`\^^^=\other + \catcode`\^^_=\other + % It was suggested to set the catcode of ^ to 7, which would allow ^^e4 etc. + % in xref tags, i.e., node names. But since ^^e4 notation isn't + % supported in the main text, it doesn't seem desirable. Furthermore, + % that is not enough: for node names that actually contain a ^ + % character, we would end up writing a line like this: 'xrdef {'hat + % b-title}{'hat b} and \xrdef does a \csname...\endcsname on the first + % argument, and \hat is not an expandable control sequence. It could + % all be worked out, but why? Either we support ^^ or we don't. + % + % The other change necessary for this was to define \auxhat: + % \def\auxhat{\def^{'hat }}% extra space so ok if followed by letter + % and then to call \auxhat in \setq. + % + \catcode`\^=\other + % + % Special characters. Should be turned off anyway, but... + \catcode`\~=\other + \catcode`\[=\other + \catcode`\]=\other + \catcode`\"=\other + \catcode`\_=\other + \catcode`\|=\other + \catcode`\<=\other + \catcode`\>=\other + \catcode`\$=\other + \catcode`\#=\other + \catcode`\&=\other + \catcode`\%=\other + \catcode`+=\other % avoid \+ for paranoia even though we've turned it off + % + % Make the characters 128-255 be printing characters + {% + \count 1=128 + \def\loop{% + \catcode\count 1=\other + \advance\count 1 by 1 + \ifnum \count 1<256 \loop \fi + }% }% -}% -% the aux file uses ' as the escape. -% Turn off \ as an escape so we do not lose on -% entries which were dumped with control sequences in their names. -% For example, 'xrdef {$\leq $-fun}{page ...} made by @defun ^^ -% Reference to such entries still does not work the way one would wish, -% but at least they do not bomb out when the aux file is read in. -\catcode `\{=1 \catcode `\}=2 -\catcode `\%=\other -\catcode `\'=0 -\catcode`\^=7 % to make ^^e4 etc usable in xref tags -\catcode `\\=\other -\openin 1 \jobname.aux -\ifeof 1 \else \closein 1 \input \jobname.aux \global\havexrefstrue -\global\warnedobstrue -\fi -% Open the new aux file. Tex will close it automatically at exit. -\openout \auxfile=\jobname.aux + % + % Turn off \ as an escape so we do not lose on + % entries which were dumped with control sequences in their names. + % For example, @xrdef{$\leq $-fun}{page ...} made by @defun ^^ + % Reference to such entries still does not work the way one would wish, + % but at least they do not bomb out when the aux file is read in. + \catcode`\\=\other + % + % @ is our escape character in .aux files. + \catcode`\{=1 + \catcode`\}=2 + \catcode`\@=0 + % + \openin 1 \jobname.aux + \ifeof 1 \else + \closein 1 + \input \jobname.aux + \global\havexrefstrue + \fi + % Open the new aux file. TeX will close it automatically at exit. + \openout\auxfile=\jobname.aux \endgroup} @@ -4041,10 +6161,11 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi % The trailing space in the following definition for supereject is % vital for proper filling; pages come out unaligned when you do a % pagealignmacro call if that space before the closing brace is -% removed. +% removed. (Generally, numeric constants should always be followed by a +% space to prevent strange expansion errors.) \def\supereject{\par\penalty -20000\footnoteno =0 } -% @footnotestyle is meaningful for info output only.. +% @footnotestyle is meaningful for info output only. \let\footnotestyle=\comment \let\ptexfootnote=\footnote @@ -4053,27 +6174,40 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi % % Auto-number footnotes. Otherwise like plain. \gdef\footnote{% + \let\indent=\ptexindent + \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent \global\advance\footnoteno by \@ne \edef\thisfootno{$^{\the\footnoteno}$}% % % In case the footnote comes at the end of a sentence, preserve the % extra spacing after we do the footnote number. \let\@sf\empty - \ifhmode\edef\@sf{\spacefactor\the\spacefactor}\/\fi + \ifhmode\edef\@sf{\spacefactor\the\spacefactor}\ptexslash\fi % % Remove inadvertent blank space before typesetting the footnote number. \unskip \thisfootno\@sf - \footnotezzz + \dofootnote }% % Don't bother with the trickery in plain.tex to not require the % footnote text as a parameter. Our footnotes don't need to be so general. % -\long\gdef\footnotezzz#1{\insert\footins{% +% Oh yes, they do; otherwise, @ifset and anything else that uses +% \parseargline fail inside footnotes because the tokens are fixed when +% the footnote is read. --karl, 16nov96. +% +% The start of the footnote looks usually like this: +\gdef\startfootins{\insert\footins\bgroup} +% +% ... but this macro is redefined inside @multitable. +% +\gdef\dofootnote{% + \startfootins % We want to typeset this text as a normal paragraph, even if the % footnote reference occurs in (for example) a display environment. % So reset some parameters. + \hsize=\pagewidth \interlinepenalty\interfootnotelinepenalty \splittopskip\ht\strutbox % top baseline for broken footnotes \splitmaxdepth\dp\strutbox @@ -4084,37 +6218,27 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi \xspaceskip\z@skip \parindent\defaultparindent % - % Hang the footnote text off the number. - \hang + \smallfonts \rm + % + % Because we use hanging indentation in footnotes, a @noindent appears + % to exdent this text, so make it be a no-op. makeinfo does not use + % hanging indentation so @noindent can still be needed within footnote + % text after an @example or the like (not that this is good style). + \let\noindent = \relax + % + % Hang the footnote text off the number. Use \everypar in case the + % footnote extends for more than one paragraph. + \everypar = {\hang}% \textindent{\thisfootno}% % % Don't crash into the line above the footnote text. Since this % expands into a box, it must come within the paragraph, lest it % provide a place where TeX can split the footnote. \footstrut - #1\strut}% + \futurelet\next\fo@t } - }%end \catcode `\@=11 -% Set the baselineskip to #1, and the lineskip and strut size -% correspondingly. There is no deep meaning behind these magic numbers -% used as factors; they just match (closely enough) what Knuth defined. -% -\def\lineskipfactor{.08333} -\def\strutheightpercent{.70833} -\def\strutdepthpercent {.29167} -% -\def\setleading#1{% - \normalbaselineskip = #1\relax - \normallineskip = \lineskipfactor\normalbaselineskip - \normalbaselines - \setbox\strutbox =\hbox{% - \vrule width0pt height\strutheightpercent\baselineskip - depth \strutdepthpercent \baselineskip - }% -} - % @| inserts a changebar to the left of the current line. It should % surround any changed text. This approach does *not* work if the % change spans more than two lines of output. To handle that, we would @@ -4150,31 +6274,121 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi % \def\finalout{\overfullrule=0pt} +% @image. We use the macros from epsf.tex to support this. +% If epsf.tex is not installed and @image is used, we complain. +% +% Check for and read epsf.tex up front. If we read it only at @image +% time, we might be inside a group, and then its definitions would get +% undone and the next image would fail. +\openin 1 = epsf.tex +\ifeof 1 \else + \closein 1 + % Do not bother showing banner with epsf.tex v2.7k (available in + % doc/epsf.tex and on ctan). + \def\epsfannounce{\toks0 = }% + \input epsf.tex +\fi +% +% We will only complain once about lack of epsf.tex. +\newif\ifwarnednoepsf +\newhelp\noepsfhelp{epsf.tex must be installed for images to + work. It is also included in the Texinfo distribution, or you can get + it from ftp://tug.org/tex/epsf.tex.} +% +\def\image#1{% + \ifx\epsfbox\undefined + \ifwarnednoepsf \else + \errhelp = \noepsfhelp + \errmessage{epsf.tex not found, images will be ignored}% + \global\warnednoepsftrue + \fi + \else + \imagexxx #1,,,,,\finish + \fi +} +% +% Arguments to @image: +% #1 is (mandatory) image filename; we tack on .eps extension. +% #2 is (optional) width, #3 is (optional) height. +% #4 is (ignored optional) html alt text. +% #5 is (ignored optional) extension. +% #6 is just the usual extra ignored arg for parsing this stuff. +\newif\ifimagevmode +\def\imagexxx#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6\finish{\begingroup + \catcode`\^^M = 5 % in case we're inside an example + \normalturnoffactive % allow _ et al. in names + % If the image is by itself, center it. + \ifvmode + \imagevmodetrue + \nobreak\bigskip + % Usually we'll have text after the image which will insert + % \parskip glue, so insert it here too to equalize the space + % above and below. + \nobreak\vskip\parskip + \nobreak + \line\bgroup\hss + \fi + % + % Output the image. + \ifpdf + \dopdfimage{#1}{#2}{#3}% + \else + % \epsfbox itself resets \epsf?size at each figure. + \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfxsize=#2\relax \fi + \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfysize=#3\relax \fi + \epsfbox{#1.eps}% + \fi + % + \ifimagevmode \hss \egroup \bigbreak \fi % space after the image +\endgroup} -% End of control word definitions. -\message{and turning on texinfo input format.} +\message{localization,} +% and i18n. -\def\openindices{% - \newindex{cp}% - \newcodeindex{fn}% - \newcodeindex{vr}% - \newcodeindex{tp}% - \newcodeindex{ky}% - \newcodeindex{pg}% +% @documentlanguage is usually given very early, just after +% @setfilename. If done too late, it may not override everything +% properly. Single argument is the language abbreviation. +% It would be nice if we could set up a hyphenation file here. +% +\def\documentlanguage{\parsearg\dodocumentlanguage} +\def\dodocumentlanguage#1{% + \tex % read txi-??.tex file in plain TeX. + % Read the file if it exists. + \openin 1 txi-#1.tex + \ifeof1 + \errhelp = \nolanghelp + \errmessage{Cannot read language file txi-#1.tex}% + \let\temp = \relax + \else + \def\temp{\input txi-#1.tex }% + \fi + \temp + \endgroup } +\newhelp\nolanghelp{The given language definition file cannot be found or +is empty. Maybe you need to install it? In the current directory +should work if nowhere else does.} + -% Set some numeric style parameters, for 8.5 x 11 format. +% @documentencoding should change something in TeX eventually, most +% likely, but for now just recognize it. +\let\documentencoding = \comment -%\hsize = 6.5in + +% Page size parameters. +% \newdimen\defaultparindent \defaultparindent = 15pt -\parindent = \defaultparindent -\parskip 18pt plus 1pt -\setleading{15pt} -\advance\topskip by 1.2cm + +\chapheadingskip = 15pt plus 4pt minus 2pt +\secheadingskip = 12pt plus 3pt minus 2pt +\subsecheadingskip = 9pt plus 2pt minus 2pt % Prevent underfull vbox error messages. -\vbadness=10000 +\vbadness = 10000 + +% Don't be so finicky about underfull hboxes, either. +\hbadness = 2000 % Following George Bush, just get rid of widows and orphans. \widowpenalty=10000 @@ -4183,90 +6397,182 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi % Use TeX 3.0's \emergencystretch to help line breaking, but if we're % using an old version of TeX, don't do anything. We want the amount of % stretch added to depend on the line length, hence the dependence on -% \hsize. This makes it come to about 9pt for the 8.5x11 format. +% \hsize. We call this whenever the paper size is set. % -\ifx\emergencystretch\thisisundefined - % Allow us to assign to \emergencystretch anyway. - \def\emergencystretch{\dimen0}% -\else - \emergencystretch = \hsize - \divide\emergencystretch by 45 -\fi +\def\setemergencystretch{% + \ifx\emergencystretch\thisisundefined + % Allow us to assign to \emergencystretch anyway. + \def\emergencystretch{\dimen0}% + \else + \emergencystretch = .15\hsize + \fi +} -% Use @smallbook to reset parameters for 7x9.5 format (or else 7x9.25) -\def\smallbook{ +% Parameters in order: 1) textheight; 2) textwidth; 3) voffset; +% 4) hoffset; 5) binding offset; 6) topskip; 7) physical page height; 8) +% physical page width. +% +% We also call \setleading{\textleading}, so the caller should define +% \textleading. The caller should also set \parskip. +% +\def\internalpagesizes#1#2#3#4#5#6#7#8{% + \voffset = #3\relax + \topskip = #6\relax + \splittopskip = \topskip + % + \vsize = #1\relax + \advance\vsize by \topskip + \outervsize = \vsize + \advance\outervsize by 2\topandbottommargin + \pageheight = \vsize + % + \hsize = #2\relax + \outerhsize = \hsize + \advance\outerhsize by 0.5in + \pagewidth = \hsize + % + \normaloffset = #4\relax + \bindingoffset = #5\relax + % + \ifpdf + \pdfpageheight #7\relax + \pdfpagewidth #8\relax + \fi + % + \setleading{\textleading} + % + \parindent = \defaultparindent + \setemergencystretch +} -% These values for secheadingskip and subsecheadingskip are -% experiments. RJC 7 Aug 1992 -% was 17pt and 14pt plus 6pt minus 3pt -\global\secheadingskip = 0pt plus 4pt minus 4pt -\global\subsecheadingskip = 0pt plus 4pt minus 4pt +% @letterpaper (the default). +\def\letterpaper{{\globaldefs = 1 + \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt + \textleading = 13.2pt + % + % If page is nothing but text, make it come out even. + \internalpagesizes{46\baselineskip}{6in}% + {\voffset}{.25in}% + {\bindingoffset}{36pt}% + {11in}{8.5in}% +}} -\global\lispnarrowing = 0.3in -\setleading{12pt} -\advance\topskip by -1cm -\global\parskip 3pt plus 1pt -\global\hsize = 5in -\global\vsize=7.5in -\global\tolerance=700 -\global\hfuzz=1pt -\global\contentsrightmargin=0pt -\global\deftypemargin=0pt -\global\defbodyindent=.5cm +% Use @smallbook to reset parameters for 7x9.5 (or so) format. +\def\smallbook{{\globaldefs = 1 + \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt + \textleading = 12pt + % + \internalpagesizes{7.5in}{5in}% + {\voffset}{.25in}% + {\bindingoffset}{16pt}% + {9.25in}{7in}% + % + \lispnarrowing = 0.3in + \tolerance = 700 + \hfuzz = 1pt + \contentsrightmargin = 0pt + \defbodyindent = .5cm +}} -\global\pagewidth=\hsize -\global\pageheight=\vsize +% Use @afourpaper to print on European A4 paper. +\def\afourpaper{{\globaldefs = 1 + \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt + \textleading = 13.2pt + % + % Double-side printing via postscript on Laserjet 4050 + % prints double-sided nicely when \bindingoffset=10mm and \hoffset=-6mm. + % To change the settings for a different printer or situation, adjust + % \normaloffset until the front-side and back-side texts align. Then + % do the same for \bindingoffset. You can set these for testing in + % your texinfo source file like this: + % @tex + % \global\normaloffset = -6mm + % \global\bindingoffset = 10mm + % @end tex + \internalpagesizes{51\baselineskip}{160mm} + {\voffset}{\hoffset}% + {\bindingoffset}{44pt}% + {297mm}{210mm}% + % + \tolerance = 700 + \hfuzz = 1pt + \contentsrightmargin = 0pt + \defbodyindent = 5mm +}} -\global\let\smalllisp=\smalllispx -\global\let\smallexample=\smalllispx -\global\def\Esmallexample{\Esmalllisp} -} +% Use @afivepaper to print on European A5 paper. +% From romildo@urano.iceb.ufop.br, 2 July 2000. +% He also recommends making @example and @lisp be small. +\def\afivepaper{{\globaldefs = 1 + \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt minus 0.1pt + \textleading = 12.5pt + % + \internalpagesizes{160mm}{120mm}% + {\voffset}{\hoffset}% + {\bindingoffset}{8pt}% + {210mm}{148mm}% + % + \lispnarrowing = 0.2in + \tolerance = 800 + \hfuzz = 1.2pt + \contentsrightmargin = 0pt + \defbodyindent = 2mm + \tableindent = 12mm +}} -% Use @afourpaper to print on European A4 paper. -\def\afourpaper{ -\global\tolerance=700 -\global\hfuzz=1pt -\setleading{12pt} -\global\parskip 15pt plus 1pt - -\global\vsize= 53\baselineskip -\advance\vsize by \topskip -%\global\hsize= 5.85in % A4 wide 10pt -\global\hsize= 6.5in -\global\outerhsize=\hsize -\global\advance\outerhsize by 0.5in -\global\outervsize=\vsize -\global\advance\outervsize by 0.6in - -\global\pagewidth=\hsize -\global\pageheight=\vsize -} - -% Allow control of the text dimensions. Parameters in order: textheight; -% textwidth; \voffset; \hoffset (!); binding offset. All require a dimension; -% header is additional; added length extends the bottom of the page. - -\def\changepagesizes#1#2#3#4#5{ - \global\vsize= #1 - \advance\vsize by \topskip - \global\voffset= #3 - \global\hsize= #2 - \global\outerhsize=\hsize - \global\advance\outerhsize by 0.5in - \global\outervsize=\vsize - \global\advance\outervsize by 0.6in - \global\pagewidth=\hsize - \global\pageheight=\vsize - \global\normaloffset= #4 - \global\bindingoffset= #5} - -% This layout is compatible with Latex on A4 paper. - -\def\afourlatex{\changepagesizes{22cm}{15cm}{7mm}{4.6mm}{5mm}} - -% Use @afourwide to print on European A4 paper in wide format. -\def\afourwide{\afourpaper -\changepagesizes{9.5in}{6.5in}{\hoffset}{\normaloffset}{\bindingoffset}} +% A specific text layout, 24x15cm overall, intended for A4 paper. +\def\afourlatex{{\globaldefs = 1 + \afourpaper + \internalpagesizes{237mm}{150mm}% + {\voffset}{4.6mm}% + {\bindingoffset}{7mm}% + {297mm}{210mm}% + % + % Must explicitly reset to 0 because we call \afourpaper. + \globaldefs = 0 +}} + +% Use @afourwide to print on A4 paper in landscape format. +\def\afourwide{{\globaldefs = 1 + \afourpaper + \internalpagesizes{241mm}{165mm}% + {\voffset}{-2.95mm}% + {\bindingoffset}{7mm}% + {297mm}{210mm}% + \globaldefs = 0 +}} + +% @pagesizes TEXTHEIGHT[,TEXTWIDTH] +% Perhaps we should allow setting the margins, \topskip, \parskip, +% and/or leading, also. Or perhaps we should compute them somehow. +% +\def\pagesizes{\parsearg\pagesizesxxx} +\def\pagesizesxxx#1{\pagesizesyyy #1,,\finish} +\def\pagesizesyyy#1,#2,#3\finish{{% + \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \hsize=#2\relax \fi + \globaldefs = 1 + % + \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt + \setleading{\textleading}% + % + \dimen0 = #1 + \advance\dimen0 by \voffset + % + \dimen2 = \hsize + \advance\dimen2 by \normaloffset + % + \internalpagesizes{#1}{\hsize}% + {\voffset}{\normaloffset}% + {\bindingoffset}{44pt}% + {\dimen0}{\dimen2}% +}} + +% Set default to letter. +% +\letterpaper + + +\message{and turning on texinfo input format.} % Define macros to output various characters with catcode for normal text. \catcode`\"=\other @@ -4277,6 +6583,7 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi \catcode`\<=\other \catcode`\>=\other \catcode`\+=\other +\catcode`\$=\other \def\normaldoublequote{"} \def\normaltilde{~} \def\normalcaret{^} @@ -4285,6 +6592,7 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi \def\normalless{<} \def\normalgreater{>} \def\normalplus{+} +\def\normaldollar{$}%$ font-lock fix % This macro is used to make a character print one way in ttfont % where it can probably just be output, and another way in other fonts, @@ -4295,7 +6603,13 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi % interword stretch (and shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all % typewriter fonts to have this, we can check that font parameter. % -\def\ifusingtt#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen3\the\font=0pt #1\else #2\fi} +\def\ifusingtt#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen3\font=0pt #1\else #2\fi} + +% Same as above, but check for italic font. Actually this also catches +% non-italic slanted fonts since it is impossible to distinguish them from +% italic fonts. But since this is only used by $ and it uses \sl anyway +% this is not a problem. +\def\ifusingit#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen1\font>0pt #1\else #2\fi} % Turn off all special characters except @ % (and those which the user can use as if they were ordinary). @@ -4303,29 +6617,21 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi % use math or other variants that look better in normal text. \catcode`\"=\active -\def\activedoublequote{{\tt \char '042}} +\def\activedoublequote{{\tt\char34}} \let"=\activedoublequote \catcode`\~=\active -\def~{{\tt \char '176}} +\def~{{\tt\char126}} \chardef\hat=`\^ \catcode`\^=\active -\def\auxhat{\def^{'hat}} \def^{{\tt \hat}} \catcode`\_=\active \def_{\ifusingtt\normalunderscore\_} % Subroutine for the previous macro. -\def\_{\lvvmode \kern.06em \vbox{\hrule width.3em height.1ex}} - -% \lvvmode is equivalent in function to \leavevmode. -% Using \leavevmode runs into trouble when written out to -% an index file due to the expansion of \leavevmode into ``\unhbox -% \voidb@x'' ---which looks to TeX like ``\unhbox \voidb\x'' due to our -% magic tricks with @. -\def\lvvmode{\vbox to 0pt{}} +\def\_{\leavevmode \kern.07em \vbox{\hrule width.3em height.1ex}\kern .07em } \catcode`\|=\active -\def|{{\tt \char '174}} +\def|{{\tt\char124}} \chardef \less=`\< \catcode`\<=\active \def<{{\tt \less}} @@ -4334,8 +6640,8 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi \def>{{\tt \gtr}} \catcode`\+=\active \def+{{\tt \char 43}} -%\catcode 27=\active -%\def^^[{$\diamondsuit$} +\catcode`\$=\active +\def${\ifusingit{{\sl\$}}\normaldollar}%$ font-lock fix % Set up an active definition for =, but don't enable it most of the time. {\catcode`\==\active @@ -4352,45 +6658,46 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi \catcode`\@=0 -% \rawbackslashxx output one backslash character in current font +% \rawbackslashxx outputs one backslash character in current font, +% as in \char`\\. \global\chardef\rawbackslashxx=`\\ -%{\catcode`\\=\other -%@gdef@rawbackslashxx{\}} -% \rawbackslash redefines \ as input to do \rawbackslashxx. +% \rawbackslash defines an active \ to do \rawbackslashxx. +% \otherbackslash defines an active \ to be a literal `\' character with +% catcode other. {\catcode`\\=\active -@gdef@rawbackslash{@let\=@rawbackslashxx }} + @gdef@rawbackslash{@let\=@rawbackslashxx} + @gdef@otherbackslash{@let\=@realbackslash} +} + +% \realbackslash is an actual character `\' with catcode other. +{\catcode`\\=\other @gdef@realbackslash{\}} % \normalbackslash outputs one backslash in fixed width font. \def\normalbackslash{{\tt\rawbackslashxx}} -% Say @foo, not \foo, in error messages. -\escapechar=`\@ - -% \catcode 17=0 % Define control-q \catcode`\\=\active % Used sometimes to turn off (effectively) the active characters % even after parsing them. -@def@turnoffactive{@let"=@normaldoublequote -@let\=@realbackslash -@let~=@normaltilde -@let^=@normalcaret -@let_=@normalunderscore -@let|=@normalverticalbar -@let<=@normalless -@let>=@normalgreater -@let+=@normalplus} - -@def@normalturnoffactive{@let"=@normaldoublequote -@let\=@normalbackslash -@let~=@normaltilde -@let^=@normalcaret -@let_=@normalunderscore -@let|=@normalverticalbar -@let<=@normalless -@let>=@normalgreater -@let+=@normalplus} +@def@turnoffactive{% + @let"=@normaldoublequote + @let\=@realbackslash + @let~=@normaltilde + @let^=@normalcaret + @let_=@normalunderscore + @let|=@normalverticalbar + @let<=@normalless + @let>=@normalgreater + @let+=@normalplus + @let$=@normaldollar %$ font-lock fix +} + +% Same as @turnoffactive except outputs \ as {\tt\char`\\} instead of +% the literal character `\'. (Thus, \ is not expandable when this is in +% effect.) +% +@def@normalturnoffactive{@turnoffactive @let\=@normalbackslash} % Make _ and + \other characters, temporarily. % This is canceled by @fixbackslash. @@ -4409,16 +6716,29 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi % Also back turn on active characters that might appear in the input % file name, in case not using a pre-dumped format. % -@gdef@fixbackslash{@ifx\@eatinput @let\ = @normalbackslash @fi - @catcode`+=@active @catcode`@_=@active} +@gdef@fixbackslash{% + @ifx\@eatinput @let\ = @normalbackslash @fi + @catcode`+=@active + @catcode`@_=@active +} + +% Say @foo, not \foo, in error messages. +@escapechar = `@@ -%% These look ok in all fonts, so just make them not special. The @rm below -%% makes sure that the current font starts out as the newly loaded cmr10 -@catcode`@$=@other @catcode`@%=@other @catcode`@&=@other @catcode`@#=@other +% These look ok in all fonts, so just make them not special. +@catcode`@& = @other +@catcode`@# = @other +@catcode`@% = @other +@c Set initial fonts. @textfonts @rm + @c Local variables: +@c eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp) @c page-delimiter: "^\\\\message" +@c time-stamp-start: "def\\\\texinfoversion{" +@c time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H" +@c time-stamp-end: "}" @c End: